blob: 400ec6402c8801dc6c7b44832c25ded15f2b1c9c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaub3066502017-11-26 19:50:17 +01005 version 1.9
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau72e92272018-12-08 16:20:55 +01007 2018/12/08
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
961 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
962
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200963nbthread <number>
964 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
965 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
966 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
967 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
968 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
973 starting the process. See also "daemon".
974
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100975presetenv <name> <value>
976 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
977 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
978 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
979 and "unsetenv".
980
981resetenv [<name> ...]
982 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
983 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
984 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
985 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
986 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
987 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
988 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
989 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
990
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100991stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200992 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
993 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
994 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
995 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
996 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
997 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100998 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100999 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1000 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1001 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1002 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001003
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001004server-state-base <directory>
1005 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001006 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1007 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001008
1009server-state-file <file>
1010 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1011 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1012 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1013 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1014 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1015 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1016 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1017 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001018 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1019 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001020
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001021setenv <name> <value>
1022 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1023 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1024 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1025 and "unsetenv".
1026
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001027ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1029 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001030 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 for all
1031 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
1032 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance
1033 a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). For
1034 TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites"
1035 keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1036
1037ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1039 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1040 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1041 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1042 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1043 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites", and can
1044 be for instance a string such as
1045 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1046 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
1047 the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
1048 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001049
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001050ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1052 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1053 keyword to see available options.
1054
1055 Example:
1056 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001057 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001058
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001059ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1061 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001062 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 with the server,
1063 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
1064 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration,
1065 please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the
1066 "server" keyword for more information.
1067
1068ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1070 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1071 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1072 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1073 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1074 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration for
1075 TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword.
1076 Please check the "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001077
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001078ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1080 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1081 keyword to see available options.
1082
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001083ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1085 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1086 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001087 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001088 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001089 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1090 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1091 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1092 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001093 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1094 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1095 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1096
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001097ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1098 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1099 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1100 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1101
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001102stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1103 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1104 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1105 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001106 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001107 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001108
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001109 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1110 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1111 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001112
1113stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1114 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1115 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001116 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001117
1118stats maxconn <connections>
1119 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1120 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122uid <number>
1123 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1124 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1125 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1126 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1127
1128ulimit-n <number>
1129 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1130 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1131 option.
1132
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001133unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1134 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1135
1136 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1137 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1138 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1139 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1140 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1141 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1142 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1143 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1144 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1145 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1146
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001147unsetenv [<name> ...]
1148 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1149 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1150 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1151 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1152 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1153 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1154 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156user <user name>
1157 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1158 See also "uid" and "group".
1159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001160node <name>
1161 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1162
1163 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1164 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1165 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1166 traffic.
1167
1168description <text>
1169 Add a text that describes the instance.
1170
1171 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1172 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1173 "<" and ">" characters.
1174
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100117551degrees-data-file <file path>
1176 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001178
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001179 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001180 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1181
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000118251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001183 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1184 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1185 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1186
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001187 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001188 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1189
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200119051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001191 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1192 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1193
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001194 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1195 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1196
119751degrees-cache-size <number>
1198 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1199 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1200 By default, this cache is disabled.
1201
1202 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001203 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1204
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001205wurfl-data-file <file path>
1206 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1207 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1208
1209 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1210 with USE_WURFL=1.
1211
1212wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1213 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1214 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1215 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1216
1217 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1218
1219 Valid WURFL properties are:
1220 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1221
1222 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1223 device.
1224
1225 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1226 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1227
1228 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1229 particular web request.
1230
1231 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1232 used Libwurfl API version.
1233
1234 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1235 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1236 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1237
1238 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1239 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1240
1241 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1242 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1243
1244 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1245
1246 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1247
1248 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1249 with USE_WURFL=1.
1250
1251wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1252 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1253 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1254
1255 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1256 with USE_WURFL=1.
1257
1258wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1259 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1260 thus before the chroot.
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1263 with USE_WURFL=1.
1264
1265wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1266 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1267 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001268 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001269 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001270 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001271 mode is enabled by default.
1272
1273 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1274 with USE_WURFL=1.
1275
1276wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1277 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1278 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1279 - "0" : no cache is used.
1280 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1281 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1282 the highest performing option.
1283
1284 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1285 with USE_WURFL=1.
1286
1287wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1288 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1289 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1290
1291 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1292 with USE_WURFL=1.
1293
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012953.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001296-----------------------
1297
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001298busy-polling
1299 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1300 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1301 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1302 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1303 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1304 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1305 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1306 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1307 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1308 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1309 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1310 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1311 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1312 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1313 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1314 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1315 "poll" pollers.
1316
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001317max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1318 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1319 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1320 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1321 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1322 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1323 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1324 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1325 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327maxconn <number>
1328 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1329 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1330 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001331 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1332 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1333 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1334 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001335 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1336 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1337 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1338 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1339 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001340
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001341maxconnrate <number>
1342 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1343 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1344 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1345 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1346 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1347 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1348 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1349 fairness.
1350
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001351maxcomprate <number>
1352 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001353 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001354 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1355 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1356 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001357 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001358 default value.
1359
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001360maxcompcpuusage <number>
1361 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1362 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1363 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1364 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1365 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1366 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1367 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1368 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1369
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001370maxpipes <number>
1371 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1372 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1373 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1374 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1375 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1376 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1377
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001378maxsessrate <number>
1379 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1380 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1381 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1382 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1383 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1384 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1385 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1386 fairness.
1387
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001388maxsslconn <number>
1389 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1390 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1391 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1392 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1393 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1394 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1395 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001396 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1397 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1398 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1399 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1400 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1401 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1402 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001403
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001404maxsslrate <number>
1405 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1406 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1407 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1408 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1409 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1410 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1411 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1412 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1413 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1414 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1415
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001416maxzlibmem <number>
1417 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1418 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1419 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001420 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1421 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1422 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424noepoll
1425 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1426 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001427 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428
1429nokqueue
1430 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1431 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1432 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1433
1434nopoll
1435 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1436 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001438 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001440nosplice
1441 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001442 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001443 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001444 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001445 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1446 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1447 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1448 "option splice-response".
1449
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001450nogetaddrinfo
1451 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1452 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1453
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001454noreuseport
1455 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1456 command line argument "-dR".
1457
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001458profiling.tasks { on | off }
1459 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1460 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1461 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1462 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1463 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1464 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1465 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1466 CLI.
1467
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001468spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001469 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1470 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1471 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1472 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1473 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1474 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001476ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001477 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001478 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001479 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1480 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1481 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1482 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1483 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1485 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001486 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1487 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1488 openssl configuration file uses:
1489 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1490
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001491ssl-mode-async
1492 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001493 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001494 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1495 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1496 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1497 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1498 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001499
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001500tune.buffers.limit <number>
1501 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1502 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1503 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1504 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1505 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001507 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1508 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1509 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1510 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1511 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1512 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1513 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1514 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1515 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1516
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001517tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1518 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1519 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1520 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1521 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1522
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001523tune.bufsize <number>
1524 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1525 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1526 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1527 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1528 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1529 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1530 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001531 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1532 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1533 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001534 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1535 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001536
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001537tune.chksize <number>
1538 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1539 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1540 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1541 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1542 checks whenever possible.
1543
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001544tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1545 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1546 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1547 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1548 this value. The default value is 1.
1549
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001550tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1551 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1552 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1553 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1554 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1555 change it.
1556
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001557tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1558 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001559 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1560 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001561 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1562 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1563 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1564 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1565 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1566
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001567tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1568 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1569 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1570 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1571 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1572 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1573 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1574 recommended not to change this value.
1575
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001576tune.http.cookielen <number>
1577 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1578 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1579 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1580 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1581 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1582 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1583 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1584 to change this value.
1585
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001586tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001587 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1588 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001589 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001590 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001591 configuration directives too.
1592 The default value is 1024.
1593
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001594tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1595 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1596 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1597 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1598 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1599 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1600 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001601 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1602 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1603 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001604
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001605tune.idletimer <timeout>
1606 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1607 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1608 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1609 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1610 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1611 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001612 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001613 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1614 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1615
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001616tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1617 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001618 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001619 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1620 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001621 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001622 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1623 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1624
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001625tune.lua.maxmem
1626 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1627 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1628 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1629 memory.
1630
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001631tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1632 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001633 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1634 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001635 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001636
1637tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1638 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1639 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1640 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1641 check servers.
1642
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001643tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1644 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1645 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1646 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001647 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001648
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001649tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001650 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1651 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1652 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1653 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1654 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1655 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1656 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1657 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1658 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1659 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001660
1661tune.maxpollevents <number>
1662 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1663 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1664 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1665 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1666 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1667
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001668tune.maxrewrite <number>
1669 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1670 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1671 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1672 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1673 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1674 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1675 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1676 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1677 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1678 bufsize.
1679
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001680tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1681 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1682 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1683 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1684 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1685 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1686 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1687 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1688 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1689 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1690 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1691 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1692 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1693 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1694 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1695 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1696 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1697 setting this parameter to 0.
1698
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001699tune.pipesize <number>
1700 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1701 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1702 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1703 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1704 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1705 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1706
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001707tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1708tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1709 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1710 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1711 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1712 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001713 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001714 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1715 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1716
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001717tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001718 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001719 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1720 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1721 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1722 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1723
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001724tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1725 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1726 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1727 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1728
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001729tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1730tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1731 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1732 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1733 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1734 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001735 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001736 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1737 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1738 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1739 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1740 notifying haproxy again.
1741
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001742tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001743 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1744 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1745 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001746 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001747 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001748 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001749 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1750 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1751 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001752 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1753 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001754
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001755tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001756 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001757 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1758 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1759 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1760 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1761 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1762
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001763tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1764 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001765 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001766 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1767 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1768 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1769 being used for too long.
1770
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001771tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1772 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1773 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1774 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1775 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1776 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1777 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1778 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1779 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1780 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1781 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001782 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001783 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001784
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001785tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1786 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1787 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1788 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1789 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1790 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1791 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1792 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001793 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1794 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001795
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001796tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1797 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1798 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1799 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1800 1000 entries.
1801
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001802tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1803 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1804 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1805 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1806
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001807tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001808tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001809tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1810tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1811tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001812 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1813 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1814 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1815 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1816 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1817 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1818 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1819 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001820
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001821 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1822 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1823 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1824 all available space is consumed.
1825 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1826 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1827 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001828
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001829tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1830 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001831 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001832 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001833 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001834 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1835
1836tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1837 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1838 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001839 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1840 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018423.3. Debugging
1843--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001844
1845debug
1846 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1847 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1848 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1849 system startup.
1850
1851quiet
1852 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1853 line argument "-q".
1854
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001855
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018563.4. Userlists
1857--------------
1858It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1859http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1860it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1861
1862userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001863 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001864 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1865
1866group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001867 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001868 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1869 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1870
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001871user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1872 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001873 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1874 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001875 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1876 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1877 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1878 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001879
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001880 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1881 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1882 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1883 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1884 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1885 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1886 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1887 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1888 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001889
1890 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001891 userlist L1
1892 group G1 users tiger,scott
1893 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001894
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001895 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1896 user scott insecure-password elgato
1897 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001898
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001899 userlist L2
1900 group G1
1901 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001902
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001903 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1904 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1905 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001906
1907 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001908
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001909
19103.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001911----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001912It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1913several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1914instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1915values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1916automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1917In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1918using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1919tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1920reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1921Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1922that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1923each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001924
1925peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001926 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001927 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1928
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001929disabled
1930 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1931 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1932 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1933
1934enable
1935 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1936
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001937peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1938 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1939 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1940 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1941 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1942 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1943 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1944
1945 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1946 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1947
1948 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1949 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1950 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1951 across all peers.
1952
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001953 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1954 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001955
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001956 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001957 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001958 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1959 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1960 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001961
1962 backend mybackend
1963 mode tcp
1964 balance roundrobin
1965 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1966 stick on src
1967
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001968 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1969 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001970
1971
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090019723.6. Mailers
1973------------
1974It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1975If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1976in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1977
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001978mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001979 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1980 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1981
1982mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1983 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1984
1985 Example:
1986 mailers mymailers
1987 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1988 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1989
1990 backend mybackend
1991 mode tcp
1992 balance roundrobin
1993
1994 email-alert mailers mymailers
1995 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1996 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1997
1998 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1999 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2000
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002001timeout mail <time>
2002 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2003 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2004 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2005 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2006
2007 Example:
2008 mailers mymailers
2009 timeout mail 20s
2010 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020124. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002013----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002015Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002016 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002017 - frontend <name>
2018 - backend <name>
2019 - listen <name>
2020
2021A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2022its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2023section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002025
2026A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2027connections.
2028
2029A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2030to forward incoming connections.
2031
2032A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2033parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2036'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2037case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2038
2039Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2040logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2041proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2042However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2043name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2044
2045Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2046and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002047bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002048protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2049modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2050arbitrary criteria.
2051
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002052In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2053a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002054the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002055
2056 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2057 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2058 between responses and new requests.
2059
2060 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2061 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2062 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002063 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2064 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002065
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002066 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2067 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2068 client-facing connection remains open.
2069
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002070 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2071 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002072
2073The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2074frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2075following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002076weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002077
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002078 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002079
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002080 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2081 ----+-----+-----+----
2082 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2083 ----+-----+-----+----
2084 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2085 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2086 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2087 ----+-----+-----+----
2088 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020924.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2093--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002095The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2096limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2097they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2098limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002099marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002100option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002101and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2102with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2103specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002104
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002105
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002106 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2107------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2108acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002109appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002110backlog X X X -
2111balance X - X X
2112bind - X X -
2113bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002114block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002115capture cookie - X X -
2116capture request header - X X -
2117capture response header - X X -
2118clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002119compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002120contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2121cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002122declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002123default-server X - X X
2124default_backend X X X -
2125description - X X X
2126disabled X X X X
2127dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002128email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002129email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002130email-alert mailers X X X X
2131email-alert myhostname X X X X
2132email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002133enabled X X X X
2134errorfile X X X X
2135errorloc X X X X
2136errorloc302 X X X X
2137-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2138errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002139force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002140filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002141fullconn X - X X
2142grace X X X X
2143hash-type X - X X
2144http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002145http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002146http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002147http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002148http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002149http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002150http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002151id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002152ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002153load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002154log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002155log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002156log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002157log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002158max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002159maxconn X X X -
2160mode X X X X
2161monitor fail - X X -
2162monitor-net X X X -
2163monitor-uri X X X -
2164option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2165option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2166option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2167option allbackups (*) X - X X
2168option checkcache (*) X - X X
2169option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2170option contstats (*) X X X -
2171option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2172option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002173option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002174-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2175option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002176option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002177option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002178option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002179option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002180option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002181option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002182option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002183option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002184option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002185option httpchk X - X X
2186option httpclose (*) X X X X
2187option httplog X X X X
2188option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002189option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002190option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002191option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002192option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2193option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2194option logasap (*) X X X -
2195option mysql-check X - X X
2196option nolinger (*) X X X X
2197option originalto X X X X
2198option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002199option pgsql-check X - X X
2200option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002201option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002202option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002203option smtpchk X - X X
2204option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2205option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2206option splice-request (*) X X X X
2207option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002208option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002209option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2210option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2211-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002212option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002213option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2214option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2215option tcpka X X X X
2216option tcplog X X X X
2217option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002218external-check command X - X X
2219external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002220persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2221rate-limit sessions X X X -
2222redirect - X X X
2223redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2224redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2225reqadd - X X X
2226reqallow - X X X
2227reqdel - X X X
2228reqdeny - X X X
2229reqiallow - X X X
2230reqidel - X X X
2231reqideny - X X X
2232reqipass - X X X
2233reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002234reqitarpit - X X X
2235reqpass - X X X
2236reqrep - X X X
2237-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002238reqtarpit - X X X
2239retries X - X X
2240rspadd - X X X
2241rspdel - X X X
2242rspdeny - X X X
2243rspidel - X X X
2244rspideny - X X X
2245rspirep - X X X
2246rsprep - X X X
2247server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002248server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002249server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002250source X - X X
2251srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002252stats admin - X X X
2253stats auth X X X X
2254stats enable X X X X
2255stats hide-version X X X X
2256stats http-request - X X X
2257stats realm X X X X
2258stats refresh X X X X
2259stats scope X X X X
2260stats show-desc X X X X
2261stats show-legends X X X X
2262stats show-node X X X X
2263stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002264-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2265stick match - - X X
2266stick on - - X X
2267stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002268stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002269stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002270tcp-check connect - - X X
2271tcp-check expect - - X X
2272tcp-check send - - X X
2273tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002274tcp-request connection - X X -
2275tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002276tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002277tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002278tcp-response content - - X X
2279tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002280timeout check X - X X
2281timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002282timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002283timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2284timeout connect X - X X
2285timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2286timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2287timeout http-request X X X X
2288timeout queue X - X X
2289timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002290timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002291timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2292timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002293timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002294transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002295unique-id-format X X X -
2296unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002297use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002298use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002299------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2300 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023034.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2304---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305
2306This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2307
2308
2309acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2310 Declare or complete an access list.
2311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2312 no | yes | yes | yes
2313 Example:
2314 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2315 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2316 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002318 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002319
2320
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002321appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2322 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2325 no | no | yes | yes
2326 Arguments :
2327 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2328 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2329
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002330 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002331 checked in each cookie value.
2332
2333 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2334 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2335 milliseconds.
2336
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002337 request-learn
2338 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2339 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2340 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2341 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2342 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2343 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2344
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002345 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2346 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2347 data following this prefix.
2348
2349 Example :
2350 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002352 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2353 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002354
2355 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2356 2 modes are currently supported :
2357 - path-parameters :
2358 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2359 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2360 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2361 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2362 - query-string :
2363 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2364 query string.
2365
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002366 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2367 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2368 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002370 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2371 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002372
2373
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002374backlog <conns>
2375 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2377 yes | yes | yes | no
2378 Arguments :
2379 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2380 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002381 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002382
2383 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2384 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2385 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2386 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2387 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2388 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2389 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2390 backlog parameter.
2391
2392 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2393 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2394 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2395
2396 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2397
2398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002400balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2403 yes | no | yes | yes
2404 Arguments :
2405 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2406 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2407 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2408 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2409
2410 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2411 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2412 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2413 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002414 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002415 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002416 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2417 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2418 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2419 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2420 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2421 it, so that you don't worry.
2422
2423 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2424 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2425 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2426 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2427 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2428 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2429 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2430 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002431
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002432 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2433 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2434 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2435 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2436 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2437 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2438 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2439 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2440
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002441 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002442 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002443 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2444 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002445 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002446 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2447 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2448 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2449 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2450 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002451 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2452 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2453 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2454 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2455 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2456 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2459 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2460 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2461 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2462 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2463 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2464 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2465 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002466 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002467 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002468 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2469 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2470 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002471
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002472 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2473 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2474 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2475 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2476 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2477 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2478 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2479 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2480 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2481 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2482 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2483 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002484
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002485 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002486 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2487 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2488 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2489 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2490 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2491 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2492 URIs start with a leading "/".
2493
2494 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2495 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2496 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2497 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2498
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002500 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2501
2502 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002503 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2504 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002505 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2506 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2507 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2508 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002509 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002510 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2511 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002512
2513 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2514 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2515 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2516 server will receive the request.
2517
2518 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2519 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2520 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2521 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2522 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002523 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2524 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2525 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002526
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002527 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2528 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2529 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2530 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2531 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002533 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002534 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2535 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2536 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2537
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002538 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2539 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2540 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2541
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002542 random A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
2543 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2544 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2545 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2546 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
2547 or removed. The hash-balance-factor directive can be used to
2548 further improve fairness of the load balancing, especially
2549 in situations where servers show highly variable response
2550 times.
2551
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002552 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002553 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002554 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2555 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2556 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2557 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2558 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2559 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002560 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002561 used instead.
2562
2563 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2564 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2565 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2566 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2567
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002568 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2569 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2570 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2571
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002572 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002574 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002575 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2576 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002577
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002578 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2579 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2580 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002582 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2583 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2584 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2585 NTLM relies on.
2586
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587 Examples :
2588 balance roundrobin
2589 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002590 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002591 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2592 balance hdr(host)
2593 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002594
2595 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2596 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002598 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002599 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2600 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2601 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2602 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2603
2604 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2605 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2606 defaults to 16 kB.
2607
2608 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2609 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2610
2611 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2612 Round Robin.
2613
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002614 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002615 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2616 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2617 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2618
2619 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2620
2621 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002622 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002623 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2624 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2625 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002627 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
2629
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002630bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2631bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002632 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2634 no | yes | yes | no
2635 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002636 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2637 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2638 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2639 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002640 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002641 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2642 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2643 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2644 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2645 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2646 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2647 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002648 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2649 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2650 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2651 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2652 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2653 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2654 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002655 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2656 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2657 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002658 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2659 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2660 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2661 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002662 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2663 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2664 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002665
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002666 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2667 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002668 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2669 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2670 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002671 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2672 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2673 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2674 the range.
2675
2676 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2677 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2678 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2679 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2680 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2681 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2682 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002683 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002684 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002685
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002686 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002687 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002688 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2689 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2690 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2691 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2692 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2693 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2694
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002695 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2696 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2697 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2698 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2701 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2702 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2703 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2704 in a frontend.
2705
2706 Example :
2707 listen http_proxy
2708 bind :80,:443
2709 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002710 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002711
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002712 listen http_https_proxy
2713 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002714 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002715
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002716 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2717 bind ipv6@:80
2718 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2719 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2720
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002721 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002722 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002723
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002724 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2725 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2726 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2727 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2728 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2729
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002730 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002731 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002732
2733
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002734bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002735 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2737 yes | yes | yes | yes
2738 Arguments :
2739 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2740 may be used to override a default value.
2741
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002742 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002743 option may be combined with other numbers.
2744
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002745 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002746 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2747 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2748 missing from all processes.
2749
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002750 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002751 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002752 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2753 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2754 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2755 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2756 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002757 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002758
2759 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2760 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2761 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2762 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2763 and 'even' instances.
2764
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002765 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2766 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2767 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2768 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002769
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002770 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2771 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2772
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002773 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2774 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2775 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2776
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002777 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2778 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2779
2780 Example :
2781 listen app_ip1
2782 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002783 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002784
2785 listen app_ip2
2786 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002787 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002788
2789 listen management
2790 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002791 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002792
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002793 listen management
2794 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2795 bind-process 1-4
2796
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002797 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002798
2799
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002800block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002801 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2803 no | yes | yes | yes
2804
2805 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2806 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002807 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002808 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002809 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002810 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2811 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2812 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002814 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2815 "http-request deny" instead.
2816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817 Example:
2818 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2819 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2820 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002821 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2822 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2823 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002824
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002825 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2826 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2827 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828
2829capture cookie <name> len <length>
2830 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2832 no | yes | yes | no
2833 Arguments :
2834 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2835 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2836 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2837 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002838 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002839
2840 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2841 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2842 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2843 right if it exceeds <length>.
2844
2845 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2846 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2847 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2848 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2849
2850 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2851 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2852 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2853
2854 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2855 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2856 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002857 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2858 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2859 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002860
2861 Example:
2862 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2863
2864 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002865 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002866
2867
2868capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002869 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2871 no | yes | yes | no
2872 Arguments :
2873 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002874 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2876 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2877 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2878
2879 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2880 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2881 it exceeds <length>.
2882
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002883 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002884 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2885 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002886 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2887 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2888 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2889 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002890 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002891 environments to find where the request came from.
2892
2893 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2894 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2895 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2896 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002898 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2899 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2900 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2901 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2902 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002903
2904 Example:
2905 capture request header Host len 15
2906 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002907 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002909 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002910 about logging.
2911
2912
2913capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002914 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2916 no | yes | yes | no
2917 Arguments :
2918 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002919 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002920 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2921 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2922 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2923
2924 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2925 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2926 it exceeds <length>.
2927
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002928 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002929 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2930 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2931 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002932 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2933 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2934 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2935 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002936
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002937 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2938 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2939 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2940 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2941 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002942
2943 Example:
2944 capture response header Content-length len 9
2945 capture response header Location len 15
2946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002947 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002948 about logging.
2949
2950
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002951clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002952 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2954 yes | yes | yes | no
2955 Arguments :
2956 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2957 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2958 as explained at the top of this document.
2959
2960 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2961 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2962 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2963 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2964 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2965 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2966 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2967 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002968 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002969 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002970 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002971
2972 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2973 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2974 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2975 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2976 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2977 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2978
2979 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2980 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2981
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002982 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2983 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002984
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002985compression algo <algorithm> ...
2986compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002987compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002988 Enable HTTP compression.
2989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2990 yes | yes | yes | yes
2991 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002992 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2993 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2994 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2995
2996 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002997 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2998 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2999 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003000
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003001 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003002 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003003
3004 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3005 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3006 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3007 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3008 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003009 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003010
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003011 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3012 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3013 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3014 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3015 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3016 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3017 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003018 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003019
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003020 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003021 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003022 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3023 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3024 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3025 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3026 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003027
3028 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3029 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3030 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3031 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3032 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003033 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3034 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3035 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3036 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3037 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003038 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3039 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003040
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003041 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003042 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3043 "Accept-Encoding" header
3044 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01003045 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01003046 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
3047 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003048 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3049 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3050 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3051 "multipart"
3052 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3053 header
3054 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3055 and later
3056 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3057 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003058
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003059 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
3060 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003061
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003062 Examples :
3063 compression algo gzip
3064 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003066
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003067contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003068 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3070 yes | no | yes | yes
3071 Arguments :
3072 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3073 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3074 as explained at the top of this document.
3075
3076 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003077 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003078 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003079 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003080 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3081 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3082 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3083
3084 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3085 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3086 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3087 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3088 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3089 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3090
3091 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3092 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3093 instead.
3094
3095 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3096 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3097
3098
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003099cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003100 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3101 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003102 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003103 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3105 yes | no | yes | yes
3106 Arguments :
3107 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3108 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3109 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3110 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3111 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3112 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003113 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3115 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3116
3117 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3118 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3119 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3120 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3121 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3122 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003123 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3124 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003125 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003126 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3127 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128
3129 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003130 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003131
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003132 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003133 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3134 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003135 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003136 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3137 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3138 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3139 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3140 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3141 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3142 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143
3144 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3145 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3146 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3147 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3148 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3149 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3150 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3151 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3152 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003153 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003154 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3155 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3156 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003158 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3159 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3160 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003161 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3162 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3163 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3164 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003165 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3166 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3167 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168
3169 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3170 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3171 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3172 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3173 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3174 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3175 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3176 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3177 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3178
3179 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3180 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3181 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3182 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3183 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3184 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3185 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3186 persistence cookie in the cache.
3187 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3188
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003189 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3190 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3191 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3192 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3193 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003194 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003195 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3196 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3197 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3198 they logout.
3199
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003200 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3201 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3202 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3203 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3204
3205 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3206 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3207 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3208 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3209 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3210 this attribute.
3211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003212 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003213 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003214 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3215 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3216 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3217 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3218 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3219 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003220
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003221 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3222 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3223 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3224 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3225 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3226 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3227 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3228 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003229 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003230 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3231 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3232 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3233 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3234 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3235 the site.
3236
3237 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3238 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3239 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3240 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3241 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3242 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3243 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3244 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3245 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3246 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3247 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3248 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3249 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003250 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003251 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3252 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3253
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003254 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3255 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3256 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3257 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3258 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3259 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003261 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3262 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3263 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3264 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003266 Examples :
3267 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3268 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3269 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003270 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003271
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003272 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003274
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003275declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3276 Declares a capture slot.
3277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3278 no | yes | yes | no
3279 Arguments:
3280 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3281
3282 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3283 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3284 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3285 for use in the response.
3286
3287 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003288 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003289 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3290
3291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003292default-server [param*]
3293 Change default options for a server in a backend
3294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3295 yes | no | yes | yes
3296 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003297 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3298 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3299 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3300 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003301
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003302 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003303 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3304
3305 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003307
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003308default_backend <backend>
3309 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3311 yes | yes | yes | no
3312 Arguments :
3313 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3314
3315 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3316 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3317 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3318 will catch all undetermined requests.
3319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320 Example :
3321
3322 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3323 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3324 default_backend dynamic
3325
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003326 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003327
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003328
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003329description <string>
3330 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3332 no | yes | yes | yes
3333 Arguments : string
3334
3335 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3336 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3337 it describes.
3338 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3339
3340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003341disabled
3342 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3344 yes | yes | yes | yes
3345 Arguments : none
3346
3347 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3348 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3349 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3350 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3351 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3352 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3353 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3354
3355 See also : "enabled"
3356
3357
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003358dispatch <address>:<port>
3359 Set a default server address
3360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3361 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003362 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003363
3364 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3365 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3366 during start-up.
3367
3368 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3369 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3370 possible with normal servers.
3371
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003372 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003373 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3374 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3375 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3376 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3377
3378 See also : "server"
3379
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003380
3381dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3382 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3384 yes | no | yes | yes
3385 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3386
3387 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003388 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003389 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3390 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003392 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003394enabled
3395 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3397 yes | yes | yes | yes
3398 Arguments : none
3399
3400 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3401 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3402
3403 See also : "disabled"
3404
3405
3406errorfile <code> <file>
3407 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | yes | yes | yes
3410 Arguments :
3411 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003412 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3413 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003414
3415 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003416 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003417 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003418 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3419 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
3421 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3422 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3423 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3424
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003425 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3426
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003427 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3428 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3429 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3430 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3431
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003432 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3433 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003434 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003435 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3436 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3437 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003439 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3440 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3441 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003442 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003443 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3444
3445 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3446
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003447 Example :
3448 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003449 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003450 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3451 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3452
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003453
3454errorloc <code> <url>
3455errorloc302 <code> <url>
3456 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3458 yes | yes | yes | yes
3459 Arguments :
3460 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003461 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3462 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003463
3464 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3465 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3466 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3467 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003468 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003469
3470 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3471 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3472 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3473
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003474 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3475
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003476 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3477 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3478 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3479 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003480 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003481 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3482 request.
3483
3484 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3485
3486
3487errorloc303 <code> <url>
3488 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3490 yes | yes | yes | yes
3491 Arguments :
3492 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003493 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3494 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003495
3496 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3497 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3498 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3499 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003500 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003501
3502 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3503 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3504 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3505
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003506 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3507
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003508 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3509 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3510 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3511 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003512 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003513
3514 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3515
3516
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003517email-alert from <emailaddr>
3518 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003519 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003520 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3521 yes | yes | yes | yes
3522
3523 Arguments :
3524
3525 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3526
3527 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3528 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3529
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003530 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003531 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3532 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003533
3534
3535email-alert level <level>
3536 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3537 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3538 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3539 yes | yes | yes | yes
3540
3541 Arguments :
3542
3543 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3544 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3545 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3546
3547 By default level is alert
3548
3549 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3550 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3551 for the proxy.
3552
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003553 Alerts are sent when :
3554
3555 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3556 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3557 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3558 is notice or lower
3559 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3560 and a health check status update occurs
3561
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003562 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3563 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003564 section 3.6 about mailers.
3565
3566
3567email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3568 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3570 yes | yes | yes | yes
3571
3572 Arguments :
3573
3574 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3575
3576 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3577 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3578
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003579 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3580 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003581
3582
3583email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3584 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3585 mailers.
3586 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3587 yes | yes | yes | yes
3588
3589 Arguments :
3590
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003591 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003592
3593 By default the systems hostname is used.
3594
3595 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3596 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3597 for the proxy.
3598
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003599 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3600 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003601
3602
3603email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003604 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003605 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3607 yes | yes | yes | yes
3608
3609 Arguments :
3610
3611 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3612
3613 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3614 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3615
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003616 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003617 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3618
3619
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003620force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3621 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3622 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003623 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003624
3625 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3626 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3627 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3628 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3629 marked down for maintenance operations.
3630
3631 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3632 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3633 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3634 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3635 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3636 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3637 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3638 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3639 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3640
3641 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3642 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3643 is used.
3644
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003645 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003646 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003647
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003648
3649filter <name> [param*]
3650 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3652 no | yes | yes | yes
3653 Arguments :
3654 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3655 referenced in section 9.
3656
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003657 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003658 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003659 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3660 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003661
3662 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3663 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3664
3665 Example:
3666 listen
3667 bind *:80
3668
3669 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3670 filter compression
3671 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3672
3673 compression algo gzip
3674 compression offload
3675
3676 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3677
3678 See also : section 9.
3679
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003680
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003681fullconn <conns>
3682 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3684 yes | no | yes | yes
3685 Arguments :
3686 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3687 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3688
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003689 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003690 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003691 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003692 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3693 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3694 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3695 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3696 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003697 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003698
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003699 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3700 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003701 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3702 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3703 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003704
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003705 Example :
3706 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3707 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3708 # connections.
3709 backend dynamic
3710 fullconn 10000
3711 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3712 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3713
3714 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3715
3716
3717grace <time>
3718 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003720 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003721 Arguments :
3722 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3723 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3724 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3725
3726 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3727 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003728 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003729 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3730
3731 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3732 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3733 simplify it.
3734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003735
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003736hash-balance-factor <factor>
3737 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | no | no | yes
3740 Arguments :
3741 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3742 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3743 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3744
3745 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3746 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3747 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3748 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3749 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3750 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3751 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3752
3753 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3754 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3755 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3756 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3757 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3758
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003759 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3760 consistent hashing mechanism.
3761
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003762 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3763
3764
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003765hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003766 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3768 yes | no | yes | yes
3769 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003770 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3771 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003772
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003773 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3774 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3775 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3776 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3777 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3778 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3779 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3780 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3781 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3782 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003783
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003784 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3785 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3786 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3787 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3788 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3789 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3790 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3791 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3792 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3793 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3794 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3795 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3796 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003797 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3798 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003799
3800 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3801
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003802 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003803 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3804 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3805 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003806 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3807 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3808 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003809
3810 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3811 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003812 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3813 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3814 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3815 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3816
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003817 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3818 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3819 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3820 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3821 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3822 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3823 parameter.
3824
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003825 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3826 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3827 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3828 used on strings.
3829
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003830 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3831
3832 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3833 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3834 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3835 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3836 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3837 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3838 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3839 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3840 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3841 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3842 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3843 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003844
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003845 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3846 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3847 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003848
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003849 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003850
3851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003852http-check disable-on-404
3853 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003855 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003856 Arguments : none
3857
3858 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3859 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3860 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3861 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3862 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3863 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3864 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3865 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003866 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3867 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3868 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3869
3870 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3871
3872
3873http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003874 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003876 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003877 Arguments :
3878 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3879 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003880 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003881 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3882 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3883 details on the supported keywords.
3884
3885 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3886 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3887 with the usual backslash ('\').
3888
3889 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3890 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3891 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3892 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3893 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3894
3895 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003896 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003897 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3898 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3899 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3900
3901 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003902 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003903 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3904 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3905 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3906 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3907
3908 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003909 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003910 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3911 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3912 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3913 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3914 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003915 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003916 trace).
3917
3918 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003919 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003920 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3921 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3922 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3923 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3924 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003925 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003926
3927 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3928 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3929 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3930 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3931 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3932 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3933 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3934 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3935
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003936 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3937 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3938 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3939
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003940 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3941 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3942
3943 Examples :
3944 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003945 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003946
3947 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003948 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003949
3950 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003951 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003952
3953 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003954 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003955
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003956 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003957
3958
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003959http-check send-state
3960 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3962 yes | no | yes | yes
3963 Arguments : none
3964
3965 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3966 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3967 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3968 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3969 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3970
3971 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3972 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3973 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3974 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3975 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003976 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3977 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3978 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3979
3980 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3981 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3982 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3983
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003984 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3985 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3986 checked in multiple backends.
3987
3988 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3989 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3990
3991 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3992 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3993 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3994 one fails.
3995
3996 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3997 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3998 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3999
4000 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4001 server's queue.
4002
4003 Example of a header received by the application server :
4004 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4005 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4006
4007 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004009
4010http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004011 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4012
4013 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4014 no | yes | yes | yes
4015
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004016 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4017 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4018 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4019 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4020 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004022 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4023 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004025 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004027 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4028 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4029 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4030 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004032 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4033 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4034 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4035 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004037 Example:
4038 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4039 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4040 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004042 http-request allow if nagios
4043 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4044 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4045 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004047 Example:
4048 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4049 acl add path /addacl
4050 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004052 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004054 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4055 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004057 Example:
4058 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4059 acl setmap path /setmap
4060 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004062 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004064 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4065 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004067 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4068 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004070http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004072 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4073 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4074 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4075 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4076 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4077 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4078 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4079 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004081http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004083 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4084 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4085 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4086 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4087 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4088 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4089 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4090 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004092http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004094 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4095 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004096
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004098http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004100 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4101 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4102 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4103 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4104 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004106 Example:
4107 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4108 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004110http-request cache-use [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004112 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004114http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4115 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004117 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4118 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4119 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4120 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4121 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4122 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4123 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4124 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4125 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004127 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4128 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4129 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4130 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4131 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4132 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004134http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004136 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4137 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4138 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4139 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4140 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4141 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004143http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004145 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004147http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004149 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4150 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4151 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4152 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4153 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4154 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004156http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004158 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4159 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4160 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4161 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4162 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004163
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004164http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4165
4166 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4167 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4168 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4169 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004170 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4171 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004172
4173 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4174
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004175http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004177 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4178 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4179 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4180 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4181 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004183http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004185 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4186 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4187 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4188 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004190http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4191 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004193 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4194 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4195 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4196 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4197 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4198 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4199 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4200 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004202 Example:
4203 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205 # applied to:
4206 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004208 # outputs:
4209 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004210
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004211 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004213http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4214 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004216 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4217 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4218 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4219 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004221 Example:
4222 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004224 # applied to:
4225 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004227 # outputs:
4228 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004230http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4231http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4234 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4235 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004237http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004239 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4240 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4241 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004243http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004245 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4246 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4247 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4248 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4249 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004251 Arguments:
4252 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4253 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004255 Example:
4256 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4257 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4260 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4265 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4266 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004267
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004268 Arguments:
4269 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4270 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272 Example:
4273 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4274 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4277 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4278 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4283 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4284 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4285 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4286 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288 Example:
4289 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4290 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4291 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4292 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4293 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4294 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4295 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4296 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4297 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4302 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4303 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4304 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4305 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4308 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004310 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4311 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4312 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4313 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4314 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4315 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4316 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4317 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4318 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4323 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4324 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4325 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4326 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4327 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4328 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004332 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4333 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4334 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004336http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4339 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4340 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4341 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4342 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4343 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4344 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4345 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004347http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004349 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4350 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4351 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4352 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4353 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4354 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356 Example :
4357 # prepend the host name before the path
4358 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004360http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4363 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4364 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4365 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4366 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004368http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004370 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4371 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4372 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4373 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4374 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4375 values have higher priority.
4376 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4377 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4378 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4379 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4380 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004382http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4385 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4386 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4387 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4388 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4389 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4390 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004392 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004393
4394 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4396 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4399 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4400 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4401 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4402 privacy.
4403
4404 Arguments :
4405 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4406 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004407
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004408 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4410 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4411
4412 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4413 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4414
4415http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4416
4417 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4418 expression.
4419
4420 Arguments:
4421 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4422 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004423
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004424 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004425 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4426 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4427
4428 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4429 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4430 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4431
4432http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4433
4434 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4435 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4436 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4437 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4438 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4439 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4440 information from the request.
4441
4442 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4443
4444http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4445
4446 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4447 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4448 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4449 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4450 path and the query string.
4451 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4452
4453http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4454
4455 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4456 inline.
4457
4458 Arguments:
4459 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4460 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4461 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4462 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4463 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4464 (request and response)
4465 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4466 processing
4467 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4468 processing
4469 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4470 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4471 and '_'.
4472
4473 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4474 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004475
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004476 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004477 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004479http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4480 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4483 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4484 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4485 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4486 agent name must be used.
4487
4488 Arguments:
4489 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4490
4491 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4492 configuration.
4493
4494http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4495
4496 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4497 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4498 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4499 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4500 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4501 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4502 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4503 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4504 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4505 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4506 action.
4507 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4508 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4509 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4510 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4511 you fully understand how it works.
4512
4513http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4514
4515 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4516 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4517 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4518 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4519 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4520 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4521 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4522 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4523 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4524 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4525 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4526 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4527 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4528
4529http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4530http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4531http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4532
4533 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4534 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4535 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4536 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4537 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4538 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4539 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4540 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4541 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4542 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4543 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4544 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4545
4546 Arguments :
4547 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4548 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4549 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4550 select which table entry to update the counters.
4551
4552 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4553 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4554 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4555 that table until the session ends.
4556
4557 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4558 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4559 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4560 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4561 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4562 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4563 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4564 useful information.
4565
4566 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4567 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4568 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4569 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4570 checks that make use of it.
4571
4572http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4573
4574 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004575
4576 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004581 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4582 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4583 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004584
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004585
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004586http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004587 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4588
4589 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4590 no | yes | yes | yes
4591
4592 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4593 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4594 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4595 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4596 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4597 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004599 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4600 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004601
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004602 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004603
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004604 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4605 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4606 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4607 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004608
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004609 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4610 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4611 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4612 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004613
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004614 Example:
4615 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004616
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004617 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004618
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004619 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4620 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004621
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004622 Example:
4623 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004624
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004625 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004626
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004627 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4628 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004629
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004630 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4631 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004632
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004633http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004634
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004635 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4636 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4637 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4638 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4639 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4640 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4641 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4642 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004643
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004644http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004645
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004646 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4647 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4648 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4649 example, or to pass some internal information.
4650 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4651 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4652 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004653
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004654http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004655
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004656 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4657 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004658
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004659http-response cache-store [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004660
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004661 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004662
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004663http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004664
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004665 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4666 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4667 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4668 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4669 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4670 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4671 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004672
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004673 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4674 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4675 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4676 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4677 keyword.
4678 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4679 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004680
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004681http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004683 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4684 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4685 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4686 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4687 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4688 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004690http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004691
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004692 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004693
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004694http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004696 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4697 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4698 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4699 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4700 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4701 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004702
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004703http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004704
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004705 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4706 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004707
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004708http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004709
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004710 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4711 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4712 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4713 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4714 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4715 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004716
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004717http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4718 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004719
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004720 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4721 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4722 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4723 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4724 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4725 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4726 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4727 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004728
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004729 Example:
4730 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004732 # applied to:
4733 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004734
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004735 # outputs:
4736 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004737
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004738 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004740http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4741 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004742
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004743 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4744 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4745 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4746 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004747
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004748 Example:
4749 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004750
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004751 # applied to:
4752 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004754 # outputs:
4755 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004757http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4758http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004759
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004760 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4761 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4762 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004763
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004764http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004765
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004766 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4767 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4768 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004769
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004770http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004771
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004772 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4773 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4774 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4775 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4776 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004777
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004778 Arguments:
4779 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004780
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004781 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4782 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004783
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004784http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004785
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004786 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4787 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4788 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004790http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4791
4792 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4793 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4794 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4795 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4796 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4797
4798http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4799
4800 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4801 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4802 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4803 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4804 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4805 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4806 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4807 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4808 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4809
4810http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4811
4812 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4813 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4814 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4815 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4816 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4817 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4818 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4819
4820http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4821
4822 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4823 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4824 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4825 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4826 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4827 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4828 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4829 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4830
4831http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4832 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4833
4834 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4835 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4836 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4837 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004838
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004839 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4841 http-response set-status 431
4842 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4843 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004845http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004846
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004847 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4848 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4849 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4850 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4851 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4852 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4853 based on some information from the request.
4854
4855 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4856
4857http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4858
4859 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4860 inline.
4861
4862 Arguments:
4863 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4864 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4865 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4866 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4867 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4868 (request and response)
4869 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4870 processing
4871 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4872 processing
4873 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4874 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4875 and '_'.
4876
4877 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4878 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004879
4880 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004881 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004885 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4886 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4887 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4888 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4889 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4890 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4891 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4892 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4893 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4894 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4895 action.
4896 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4897 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4898 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4899 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4900 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004902http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4903http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4904http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004906 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4907 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4908 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4909 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4910 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4911 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4912
4913http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4914
4915 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4916 about <var-name>.
4917
4918 Example:
4919 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4920
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004921
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004922http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4923 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4924
4925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4926 yes | no | yes | yes
4927
4928 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4929 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4930 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4931 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4932 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004933 This directive allows to tune this behavior.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004934
4935 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4936
4937 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4938 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4939 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4940 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4941 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4942 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4943 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4944 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4945 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4946 not checking any request past the first one.
4947
4948 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4949 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4950 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4951 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4952 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4953 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4954 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4955
4956 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4957 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4958 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4959 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4960 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4961 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4962 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4963 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4964 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4965 downsides of rare connection failures.
4966
4967 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4968 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4969 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4970 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4971 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4972 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004973 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004974 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4975 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4976 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4977 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4978 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4979
4980 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004981 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
4982 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
4983 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004984
4985 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004986 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004987
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02004988 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
4989 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004990
4991 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4992 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4993 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4994
4995 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4996 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4997 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4998
4999 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5000
5001
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005002http-send-name-header [<header>]
5003 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5004
5005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 yes | no | yes | yes
5007
5008 Arguments :
5009
5010 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5011
5012 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005013 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005014 is added with the header string proved.
5015
5016 See also : "server"
5017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005018id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005019 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5021 no | yes | yes | yes
5022 Arguments : none
5023
5024 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5025 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5026 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005027
5028
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005029ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5030 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005032 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005033
5034 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5035 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5036 and running).
5037
5038 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5039 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5040 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005041 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005042 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5043
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005044 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5045 "unless" condition is met.
5046
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005047 Example:
5048 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5049 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5050 ignore-persist if url_static
5051
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005052 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5053
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005054load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5055 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5056 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5057 yes | no | yes | yes
5058
5059 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5060 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5061 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005062 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005063 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5064 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5065 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5066 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5067
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005068 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005069 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005070 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005071
5072 Arguments:
5073 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5074 named "server-state-file".
5075
5076 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5077 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5078 name is used as a file name.
5079
5080 none don't load any stat for this backend
5081
5082 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005083 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5084 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5085 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005086 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005087 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005088
5089 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5090 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5091
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005092 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005093
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005094 global
5095 stats socket /tmp/socket
5096 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005097
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005098 defaults
5099 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005100
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005101 backend bk
5102 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5103 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005104
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005105
5106 Then one can run :
5107
5108 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5109
5110 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5111
5112 1
5113 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5114 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5115 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5116
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005117 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005118
5119 global
5120 stats socket /tmp/socket
5121 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5122
5123 defaults
5124 load-server-state-from-file local
5125
5126 backend bk
5127 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5128 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5129
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005130
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005131 Then one can run :
5132
5133 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5134
5135 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5136
5137 1
5138 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5139 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5140 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5141
5142 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5143 "show servers state"
5144
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005145
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005146log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005147log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005148no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005149 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5151 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005152
5153 Prefix :
5154 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5155 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5156 prefix does not allow arguments.
5157
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005158 Arguments :
5159 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5160 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5161 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5162 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5163 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5164 parameter.
5165
5166 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5167 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5168
5169 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5170 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5171 standard syslog port).
5172
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005173 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5174 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5175 standard syslog port).
5176
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005177 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5178 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5179 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005180 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005181
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005182 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5183 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5184 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5185 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5186 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5187 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5188 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5189 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5190 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5191 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5192 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5193 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5194 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5195 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5196 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5197 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005198 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5199 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005200
5201 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5202 and "fd@2", see above.
5203
5204 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5205 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005206
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005207 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5208 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5209 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5210 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5211 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5212 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5213 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5214 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5215 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5216 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005217 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005218
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005219 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5220 one of the following :
5221
5222 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5223 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5224
5225 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5226 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5227
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005228 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5229 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5230 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5231 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5232 systemd logger consumes.
5233
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005234 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5235 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5236 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5237 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5238
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005239 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5240
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005241 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5242 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5243 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5244
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005245 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5246 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5247 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5248 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005249
5250 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5251 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5252 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005253 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5254 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5255 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5256 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5257 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005258
5259 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5260
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005261 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5262 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5263 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005264
5265 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5266 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5267 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5268 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5269
5270 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5271 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005272
5273 Example :
5274 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005275 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5276 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5277 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005278 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5279 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005280 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005281
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005282
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005283log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005284 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5285 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5286 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005287
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005288 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5289 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5290 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5291 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5292 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005293
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005294 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5295 "option httplog" directives.
5296
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005297log-format-sd <string>
5298 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5299 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5300 yes | yes | yes | no
5301
5302 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5303 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5304 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5305 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5306 which covers the log format string in depth.
5307
5308 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5309 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5310
5311 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5312 log format to "rfc5424".
5313
5314 Example :
5315 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5316
5317
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005318log-tag <string>
5319 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5320 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5321 yes | yes | yes | yes
5322
5323 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5324 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5325 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5326 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5327 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5328 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5329 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5330 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5331 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005332
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005333max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5334 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5336 yes | no | yes | yes
5337
5338 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5339 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5340 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5341 servers.
5342
5343 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5344 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5345 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5346 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5347 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005348 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005349 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5350 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5351 picking a different server.
5352
5353 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5354 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5355 even if they have to be queued.
5356
5357 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5358 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5359
5360
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005361maxconn <conns>
5362 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5364 yes | yes | yes | no
5365 Arguments :
5366 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5367 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5368 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5369 closes.
5370
5371 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5372 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5373 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5374 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005375 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5376 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5377 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5378 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005379
5380 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5381 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5382 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5383
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005384 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5385
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005386 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5387
5388
5389mode { tcp|http|health }
5390 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5392 yes | yes | yes | yes
5393 Arguments :
5394 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5395 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5396 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5397 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5398
5399 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5400 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5401 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5402 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5403 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5404
5405 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005406 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5407 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5408 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5409 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5410 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5411 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5412 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005413
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005414 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5415 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5416 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005417
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005418 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005419 defaults http_instances
5420 mode http
5421
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005422 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005423
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005424
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005425monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005426 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5428 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005429 Arguments :
5430 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5431 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005432 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005433 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5434 backend and its backup.
5435
5436 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5437 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5438 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5439 servers in a list of backends.
5440
5441 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5442 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5443 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5444 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5445 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5446 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5447 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005448 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5449 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005450
5451 Example:
5452 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005453 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005454 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5455 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5456 monitor-uri /site_alive
5457 monitor fail if site_dead
5458
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005459 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005460
5461
5462monitor-net <source>
5463 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 yes | yes | yes | no
5466 Arguments :
5467 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5468 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5469 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5470 followed by a mask.
5471
5472 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5473 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005474 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005475 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5476
5477 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5478 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5479 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5480 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005481 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5482 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5483 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005484
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005485 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5486 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5487 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5488 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5489 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5490 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005491
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005492 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5493 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005494
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005495 Example :
5496 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5497 frontend www
5498 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5499
5500 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5501
5502
5503monitor-uri <uri>
5504 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5506 yes | yes | yes | no
5507 Arguments :
5508 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5509 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5510
5511 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5512 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5513 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5514 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5515 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5516 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5517 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5518 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5519
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005520 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5521 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5522 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5523 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5524 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5525 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5526 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5527 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005528
5529 Example :
5530 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5531 frontend www
5532 mode http
5533 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5534
5535 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005537
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005538option abortonclose
5539no option abortonclose
5540 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5542 yes | no | yes | yes
5543 Arguments : none
5544
5545 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5546 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5547 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5548 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005549 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005550 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5551 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5552 encountered while delivering the response.
5553
5554 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5555 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5556 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5557 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5558 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5559 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005560 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005561 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005562 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005563 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5564 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5565 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5566
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005567 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5568 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005569 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5570 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5571 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5572 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5573 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5574 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005575 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005576
5577 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5578 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5579
5580 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5581
5582
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005583option accept-invalid-http-request
5584no option accept-invalid-http-request
5585 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5587 yes | yes | yes | no
5588 Arguments : none
5589
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005590 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005591 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005592 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005593 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5594 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5595 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5596 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5597 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005598 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5599 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5600 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5601 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005602 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005603 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005604 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5605 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5606 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005607
5608 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5609 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5610 been confirmed.
5611
5612 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5613 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005614 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5615 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005616 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5617
5618 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5619 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5620
5621 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5622 stats socket.
5623
5624
5625option accept-invalid-http-response
5626no option accept-invalid-http-response
5627 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5629 yes | no | yes | yes
5630 Arguments : none
5631
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005632 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005633 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005634 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005635 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5636 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5637 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5638 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5639 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005640 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5641 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5642 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005643
5644 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5645 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5646 been confirmed.
5647
5648 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5649 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5650 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5651 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5652
5653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5655
5656 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5657 stats socket.
5658
5659
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005660option allbackups
5661no option allbackups
5662 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5664 yes | no | yes | yes
5665 Arguments : none
5666
5667 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5668 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5669 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5670 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5671 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5672 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5673 order between the backup servers anymore.
5674
5675 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5676 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5677
5678 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5679 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5680
5681
5682option checkcache
5683no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005684 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5686 yes | no | yes | yes
5687 Arguments : none
5688
5689 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5690 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005691 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005692 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5693 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005694 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005695
5696 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005697 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005698 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005699 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5700 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005701 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005702 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005703 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5704 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005705 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005706 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5707 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005708 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005709 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5710 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5711 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5712 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5713 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5714 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5715 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5716 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5717 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5718
5719 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005720 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005721 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005722 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005723 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5724
5725 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5726 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005727 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005728 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005729
5730 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5731 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5732
5733
5734option clitcpka
5735no option clitcpka
5736 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5738 yes | yes | yes | no
5739 Arguments : none
5740
5741 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5742 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005743 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005744 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5745
5746 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5747 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5748 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5749 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5750
5751 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5752 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5753 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5754 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5755 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5756
5757 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5758
5759 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5760 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5761 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5762
5763 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5764 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5765
5766 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5767
5768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005769option contstats
5770 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5772 yes | yes | yes | no
5773 Arguments : none
5774
5775 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5776 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5777 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5778 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005779 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5780 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5781 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5782 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5783 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005784
5785
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005786option dontlog-normal
5787no option dontlog-normal
5788 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5790 yes | yes | yes | no
5791 Arguments : none
5792
5793 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5794 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5795 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5796 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5797 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5798 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5799 logged.
5800
5801 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5802 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5803 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005805 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005806 logging.
5807
5808
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005809option dontlognull
5810no option dontlognull
5811 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5813 yes | yes | yes | no
5814 Arguments : none
5815
5816 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5817 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5818 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5819 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5820 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5821 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005822 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5823 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5824 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005825
5826 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005827 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005828 would not be logged.
5829
5830 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5831 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5832
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005833 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5834 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005835
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005836
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005837option forceclose (deprecated)
5838no option forceclose (deprecated)
5839 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005840
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005841 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005842
5843
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005844option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005845 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5847 yes | yes | yes | yes
5848 Arguments :
5849 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5850 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005851 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005852 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005853
5854 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5855 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5856 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5857 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5858 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5859 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5860 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005861 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5862 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5863 possible that the client has already brought one.
5864
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005865 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005866 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005867 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005868 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005869 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005870 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005871
5872 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5873 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5874 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5875 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5876 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5877 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5878 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5879
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005880 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5881 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5882 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5883 are under the control of the end-user.
5884
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005885 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005886 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5887 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005888 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5889 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5890 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005891
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005892 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005893 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5894 frontend www
5895 mode http
5896 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5897
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005898 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5899 backend www
5900 mode http
5901 option forwardfor header X-Client
5902
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005903 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005904 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005905
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005906
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005907option http-buffer-request
5908no option http-buffer-request
5909 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5911 yes | yes | yes | yes
5912 Arguments : none
5913
5914 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5915 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5916 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5917 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5918 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5919 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5920 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5921 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005922 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005923 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5924 default.
5925
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005926 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005927
5928
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005929option http-ignore-probes
5930no option http-ignore-probes
5931 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5933 yes | yes | yes | no
5934 Arguments : none
5935
5936 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5937 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5938 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5939 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5940 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5941 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5942 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5943 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5944 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005945 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5946 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005947 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5948
5949 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5950 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5951 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5952 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5953 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5954 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5955 are often the only way to detect them.
5956
5957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5959
5960 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5961
5962
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005963option http-keep-alive
5964no option http-keep-alive
5965 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5967 yes | yes | yes | yes
5968 Arguments : none
5969
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005970 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5971 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005972 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5973 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5974 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
5975 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
5976 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005977
5978 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5979 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005980 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5981 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5982 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5983 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5984 situations where this option may be useful :
5985
5986 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005987 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005988
5989 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5990 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5991
5992 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5993 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5994 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5995 request.
5996
5997 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5998 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005999 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6000 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6001 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006002
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006003 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6004 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6005 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6006 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6007 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6008 not set.
6009
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006010 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006011 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6012 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006013
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006014 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006015 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006016 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006017
6018
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006019option http-no-delay
6020no option http-no-delay
6021 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6023 yes | yes | yes | yes
6024 Arguments : none
6025
6026 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6027 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6028 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6029 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6030 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6031 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6032 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6033 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6034 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6035 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6036 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6037 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6038 affected.
6039
6040 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6041 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6042 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6043 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6044 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6045 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6046 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6047 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6048 latency environments.
6049
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006050 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6051
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006052
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006053option http-pretend-keepalive
6054no option http-pretend-keepalive
6055 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006057 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006058 Arguments : none
6059
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006060 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006061 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6062 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6063 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6064 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6065 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6066 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6067 consider the response complete.
6068
6069 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6070 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6071 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6072 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006073 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006074 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6075
6076 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6077 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6078 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6079 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6080 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6081 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6082 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6083
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006084 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6085 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6086 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6087 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6088 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6089 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006090
6091 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6092 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6093
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006094 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006095 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006096
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006097
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006098option http-server-close
6099no option http-server-close
6100 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6102 yes | yes | yes | yes
6103 Arguments : none
6104
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006105 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6106 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6107 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6108 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006109 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6110 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6111 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6112 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6113 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6114 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6115 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6116 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6117 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6118 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6119 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006120
6121 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6122 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6123 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6124 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006125 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6126 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006127
6128 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6129 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006130 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6131 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6132 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006133
6134 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6135 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6136
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006137 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6138 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006139
6140
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006141option http-tunnel
6142no option http-tunnel
6143 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006145 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006146 Arguments : none
6147
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006148 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6149 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6150 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6151 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006152 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006153
6154 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006155 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006156 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6157 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6158 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6159 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6160 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6161 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6162 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006163
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006164 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6165 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6166 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6167 backend.
6168
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006169 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6170 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6171
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006172 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6173 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006174
6175
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006176option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006177no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006178 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6180 yes | yes | yes | no
6181 Arguments : none
6182
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006183 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006184 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6185 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6186 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6187 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6188 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6189 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6190
6191 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6192 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006193 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6194 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6195 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006196
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006197 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6198 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6199 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6200 front of an existing proxy.
6201
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006202 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006204 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006205
6206
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006207option http-use-htx
6208no option http-use-htx
6209 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6211 yes | yes | yes | yes
6212 Arguments : none
6213
6214 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6215 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6216 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6217 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6218 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6219 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6220 representation.
6221
6222 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6223 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6224 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6225 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6226 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6227 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6228 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6229 other side's version.
6230
6231 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6232 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6233 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6234 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6235 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6236
6237 See also : "mode http"
6238
6239
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006240option httpchk
6241option httpchk <uri>
6242option httpchk <method> <uri>
6243option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6244 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6246 yes | no | yes | yes
6247 Arguments :
6248 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6249 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6250 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6251 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6252 ones.
6253
6254 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6255 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6256 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6257
6258 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6259 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6260 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6261 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6262 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6263
6264 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6265 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6266 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6267 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6268 the lack of any response.
6269
6270 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6271
6272 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6273 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6274 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6275
6276 Examples :
6277 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6278 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6279 backend https_relay
6280 mode tcp
6281 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6282 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6283
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006284 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6285 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6286 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006287
6288
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006289option httpclose
6290no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006291 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | yes | yes | yes
6294 Arguments : none
6295
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006296 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6297 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6298 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6299 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006300 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006301
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006302 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6303 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6304 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6305 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6306 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006307
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006308 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6309 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6310 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006311
6312 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6313 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006314 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006315 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6316 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6317 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006318
6319 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6320 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6321
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006322 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006323
6324
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006325option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006326 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006328 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006329 Arguments :
6330 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6331 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6332 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006333 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006334 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006335
6336 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6337 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6338 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6339 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6340 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6341 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6342 ports.
6343
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006344 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6345 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006346
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006347 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006349 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006350
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006351
6352option http_proxy
6353no option http_proxy
6354 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6356 yes | yes | yes | yes
6357 Arguments : none
6358
6359 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6360 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6361 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6362 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6363 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6364
6365 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6366 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006367 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6368 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006369
6370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6372
6373 Example :
6374 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6375 backend direct_forward
6376 option httpclose
6377 option http_proxy
6378
6379 See also : "option httpclose"
6380
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006381
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006382option independent-streams
6383no option independent-streams
6384 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6386 yes | yes | yes | yes
6387 Arguments : none
6388
6389 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6390 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6391 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6392 receive data or not.
6393
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006394 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006395 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6396 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6397 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6398 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6399 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6400 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6401 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6402 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6403 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6404 socket buffers.
6405
6406 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6407 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6408 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6409 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6410 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6411
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006412 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006413 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6414 deprecated.
6415
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006416 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006417
6418
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006419option ldap-check
6420 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6422 yes | no | yes | yes
6423 Arguments : none
6424
6425 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6426 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6427 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6428 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6429
6430 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6431 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6432
6433 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6434 configure it.
6435
6436 Example :
6437 option ldap-check
6438
6439 See also : "option httpchk"
6440
6441
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006442option external-check
6443 Use external processes for server health checks
6444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6445 yes | no | yes | yes
6446
6447 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6448 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6449 command".
6450
6451 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6452
6453 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6454
6455
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006456option log-health-checks
6457no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006458 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6460 yes | no | yes | yes
6461 Arguments : none
6462
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006463 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6464 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6465 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006466
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006467 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6468 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6469 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6470 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6471 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6472
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006473 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006474 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006475
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006476 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6477 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6478 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006479
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006480
6481option log-separate-errors
6482no option log-separate-errors
6483 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6485 yes | yes | yes | no
6486 Arguments : none
6487
6488 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6489 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6490 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6491 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6492 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6493 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6494 provides very important information.
6495
6496 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6497 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6498 error logs.
6499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006500 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006501 logging.
6502
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006503
6504option logasap
6505no option logasap
6506 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6508 yes | yes | yes | no
6509 Arguments : none
6510
6511 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6512 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6513 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6514 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6515 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6516 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6517 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006518 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006519 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6520 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6521
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006522 Examples :
6523 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6524 mode http
6525 option httplog
6526 option logasap
6527 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6528
6529 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6530 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6531 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6532 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006534 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006535 logging.
6536
6537
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006538option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006539 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6541 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006542 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006543 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6544 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006545 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006546
6547 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6548 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006549 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006550 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6551 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6552 in the MySQL table, like this :
6553
6554 USE mysql;
6555 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6556 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6557
6558 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006559 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006560 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6561 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6562 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6563 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6564 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6565 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6566 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6567
6568 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6569 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006570
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006571 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006572
6573 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6574 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6575 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6576 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006577 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6578 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006579
6580 See also: "option httpchk"
6581
6582
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006583option nolinger
6584no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006585 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006586 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6587 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006588 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006589
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006590 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006591 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6592 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6593 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6594 connections.
6595
6596 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6597 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6598 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6599 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6600 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6601 this too.
6602
6603 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6604 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6605 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6606
6607 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6608 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6609 for servers.
6610
6611 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6612 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6613
6614
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006615option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6616 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6618 yes | yes | yes | yes
6619 Arguments :
6620 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6621 matching <network>
6622 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6623 header name.
6624
6625 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6626 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6627 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6628 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6629 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6630 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6631 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6632 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6633 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6634 possible that the client has already brought one.
6635
6636 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6637 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6638 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6639 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6640 header and requires different one.
6641
6642 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6643 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6644 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6645 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6646 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6647 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6648 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6649
6650 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6651 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6652 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6653 both are defined.
6654
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006655 Examples :
6656 # Original Destination address
6657 frontend www
6658 mode http
6659 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6660
6661 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6662 backend www
6663 mode http
6664 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6665
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006666 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006667
6668
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006669option persist
6670no option persist
6671 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6673 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006674 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006675
6676 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6677 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6678 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6679 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6680 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6681 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6682 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6683 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6684 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6685 redirected to another valid server.
6686
6687 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6688 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6689
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006690 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006691
6692
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006693option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6694 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6696 yes | no | yes | yes
6697 Arguments :
6698 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6699 PostgreSQL server.
6700
6701 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6702 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6703 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6704 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6705
6706 See also: "option httpchk"
6707
6708
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006709option prefer-last-server
6710no option prefer-last-server
6711 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6713 yes | no | yes | yes
6714 Arguments : none
6715
6716 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6717 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6718 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6719 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6720 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6721 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6722 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6723 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6724 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006725 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6726 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006727 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6728 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6729 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006730 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6731 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6732 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006733
6734 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6735 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6736
6737 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6738
6739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006740option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006741option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006742no option redispatch
6743 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6745 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006746 Arguments :
6747 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6748 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6749 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006750 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006751 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006752 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006753 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6754 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6755 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006757
6758 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6759 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6760 be able to access the service anymore.
6761
6762 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6763 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6764
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006765 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006766 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6767 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006769 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6770 "redisp" keywords.
6771
6772 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6773 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6774
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006775 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006776
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006777
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006778option redis-check
6779 Use redis health checks for server testing
6780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6781 yes | no | yes | yes
6782 Arguments : none
6783
6784 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6785 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6786 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6787 find the "+PONG" response message.
6788
6789 Example :
6790 option redis-check
6791
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006792 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006793
6794
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006795option smtpchk
6796option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6797 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6799 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006800 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006801 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006802 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006803 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6804
6805 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6806 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6807 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6808
6809 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6810 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6811 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6812 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6813 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6814 dead server.
6815
6816 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6817 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006818 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006819 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6820
6821 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6822 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6823 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6824 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006825 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006826
6827 Example :
6828 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6829
6830 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6831
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006833option socket-stats
6834no option socket-stats
6835
6836 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6838 yes | yes | yes | no
6839
6840 Arguments : none
6841
6842
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006843option splice-auto
6844no option splice-auto
6845 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6847 yes | yes | yes | yes
6848 Arguments : none
6849
6850 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6851 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006852 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006853 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006854 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006855 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6856 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6857 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6858 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6859
6860 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6861 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6862 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6863 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6864 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6865 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6866 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6867 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6868 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6869 keyword.
6870
6871 Example :
6872 option splice-auto
6873
6874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6876
6877 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6878 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6879
6880
6881option splice-request
6882no option splice-request
6883 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6885 yes | yes | yes | yes
6886 Arguments : none
6887
6888 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006889 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006890 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6891 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6892 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6893 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6894
6895 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6896
6897 Example :
6898 option splice-request
6899
6900 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6901 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6902
6903 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6904 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6905
6906
6907option splice-response
6908no option splice-response
6909 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6911 yes | yes | yes | yes
6912 Arguments : none
6913
6914 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006915 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006916 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6917 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6918 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6919 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6920
6921 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6922
6923 Example :
6924 option splice-response
6925
6926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6928
6929 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6930 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6931
6932
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006933option spop-check
6934 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6936 no | no | no | yes
6937 Arguments : none
6938
6939 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6940 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6941 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6942 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6943
6944 Example :
6945 option spop-check
6946
6947 See also : "option httpchk"
6948
6949
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006950option srvtcpka
6951no option srvtcpka
6952 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6954 yes | no | yes | yes
6955 Arguments : none
6956
6957 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6958 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006959 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006960 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6961
6962 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6963 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6964 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6965 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6966
6967 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6968 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6969 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6970 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6971 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6972
6973 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6974
6975 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6976 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6977 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6978
6979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6981
6982 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6983
6984
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006985option ssl-hello-chk
6986 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6988 yes | no | yes | yes
6989 Arguments : none
6990
6991 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6992 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6993 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6994 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6995 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6996 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6997 hello message.
6998
6999 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7000 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7001 messages, which is appreciable.
7002
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007003 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7004 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7005 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007006
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007007 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7008
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007009
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007010option tcp-check
7011 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7013 yes | no | yes | yes
7014
7015 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7016 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7017
7018 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7019 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7020 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7021
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007022 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007023 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7024 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7025 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7026 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7027 only.
7028
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007029 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007030 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7031 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7032 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7033 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7034
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007035 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007036 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7037 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007038 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007039 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7040 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7041 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7042 the respective protocols.
7043 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007044 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007045
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007046 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7047 script.
7048
7049 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7050 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7051 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7052 The "comment" is of course optional.
7053
7054
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007055 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007056 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007057 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007058 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007059
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007060 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007061 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007062 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007063
7064 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7065 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007066 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007067 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007068 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007069 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007070 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007071 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007072 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7073 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007074 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007075 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7076 tcp-check expect string +OK
7077
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007078 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007079 (send many headers before analyzing)
7080 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007081 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007082 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7083 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7084 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7085 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007086 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007087
7088
7089 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7090
7091
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007092option tcp-smart-accept
7093no option tcp-smart-accept
7094 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7096 yes | yes | yes | no
7097 Arguments : none
7098
7099 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7100 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7101 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7102 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7103 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7104 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7105
7106 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7107 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7108 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7109 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7110
7111 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7112 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7113 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007114 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007115
7116 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7117 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7118 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7119
7120 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7121 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7122 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7123
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007124 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7125
7126
7127option tcp-smart-connect
7128no option tcp-smart-connect
7129 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 yes | no | yes | yes
7132 Arguments : none
7133
7134 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7135 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7136 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7137 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7138 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7139
7140 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7141 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7142 complex.
7143
7144 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7145 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7146 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7147
7148 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7149 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7150
7151 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7152
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007153
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007154option tcpka
7155 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7157 yes | yes | yes | yes
7158 Arguments : none
7159
7160 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7161 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007162 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007163 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7164
7165 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7166 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7167 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7168 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7169
7170 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7171 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7172 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7173 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7174 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7175
7176 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7177
7178 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7179 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7180 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7181 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7182 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7183 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7184 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7185 backends.
7186
7187 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7188
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007189
7190option tcplog
7191 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007193 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007194 Arguments : none
7195
7196 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7197 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7198 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7199 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7200 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7201 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7202 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7203 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7204
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007205 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007207 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007208
7209
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007210option transparent
7211no option transparent
7212 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007214 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007215 Arguments : none
7216
7217 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7218 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7219 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7220 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7221 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7222 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7223 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7224 appropriate server.
7225
7226 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7227 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7228
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007229 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007230 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007231
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007232
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007233external-check command <command>
7234 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7236 yes | no | yes | yes
7237
7238 Arguments :
7239 <command> is the external command to run
7240
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007241 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7242
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007243 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007244
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007245 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7246 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7247 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7248 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7249 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7250 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007251
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007252 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7253
7254 Environment variables :
7255 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7256 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7257
7258 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7259
7260 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7261
7262 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7263 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7264 for a UNIX socket).
7265
7266 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7267
7268 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7269
7270 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7271
7272 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7273
7274 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7275
7276 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7277 socket).
7278
7279 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7280 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7281
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007282 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7283 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7284 failed.
7285
7286 Example :
7287 external-check command /bin/true
7288
7289 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7290
7291
7292external-check path <path>
7293 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7295 yes | no | yes | yes
7296
7297 Arguments :
7298 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7299
7300 The default path is "".
7301
7302 Example :
7303 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7304
7305 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7306 "external-check command"
7307
7308
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007309persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007310persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007311 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 yes | no | yes | yes
7314 Arguments :
7315 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007316 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7317 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007318
7319 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7320 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007321 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007322 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7323 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7324 forwarded to this server.
7325
7326 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7327 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7328 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007329 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007330 a single "listen" section.
7331
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007332 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7333 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7334 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7335
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007336 Example :
7337 listen tse-farm
7338 bind :3389
7339 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7340 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7341 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7342 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7343 persist rdp-cookie
7344 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007345 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007346 balance rdp-cookie
7347 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7348 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7349
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007350 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7351 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007352
7353
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007354rate-limit sessions <rate>
7355 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7357 yes | yes | yes | no
7358 Arguments :
7359 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7360 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7361
7362 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7363 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7364 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7365 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7366 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7367 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7368
7369 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7370 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7371 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7372 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7373
7374 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7375 listen smtp
7376 mode tcp
7377 bind :25
7378 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007379 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007380
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007381 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7382 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7383 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007384
7385 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7386
7387
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007388redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7389redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7390redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007391 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7393 no | yes | yes | yes
7394
7395 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007396 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007397
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007398 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007399 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007400 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7401 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7402 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007403
7404 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7405 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7406 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7407 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7408 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007409 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7410 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7411 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7412 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007413
7414 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7415 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7416 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7417 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7418 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7419 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007420 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007421 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007422 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7423 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7424 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007425
7426 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007427 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7428 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7429 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007430 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007431 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7432 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7433 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7434 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007435
7436 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007437 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007438
7439 - "drop-query"
7440 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7441 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7442 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7443 with a location-type redirect.
7444
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007445 - "append-slash"
7446 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7447 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7448 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7449 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7450
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007451 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7452 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7453 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7454 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7455 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7456 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7457 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7458
7459 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7460 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7461 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7462 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7463 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7464 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7465 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007466
7467 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7468 acl clear dst_port 80
7469 acl secure dst_port 8080
7470 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007471 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007472 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007473 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7474
7475 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007476 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7477 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7478 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007479 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007480
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007481 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7482 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7483 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7484
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007485 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007486 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007487
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007488 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007489 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7490 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7491 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007493 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007494
7495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007496redisp (deprecated)
7497redispatch (deprecated)
7498 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7499 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7500 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007501 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007502
7503 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7504 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7505 be able to access the service anymore.
7506
7507 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7508 redistribute them to a working server.
7509
7510 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7511 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7512 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007514 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7515 "option redispatch" instead.
7516
7517 See also : "option redispatch"
7518
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007519
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007520reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007521 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7523 no | yes | yes | yes
7524 Arguments :
7525 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7526 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007527 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007528
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007529 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7530 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7531
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007532 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7533 the last header of an HTTP request.
7534
7535 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7536 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7537 responses.
7538
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007539 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7540 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7541 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7542
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007543 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7544 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007545
7546
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007547reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7548reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007549 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 no | yes | yes | yes
7552 Arguments :
7553 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7554 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7555 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7556 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7557 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7558 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7559 ignores case.
7560
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007561 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7562 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7563
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007564 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7565 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7566 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7567 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007568 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007569
7570 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7571 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7572
7573 Example :
7574 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7575 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7576 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7577
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007578 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7579 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007580
7581
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007582reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7583reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007584 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7586 no | yes | yes | yes
7587 Arguments :
7588 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7589 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7590 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7591 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7592 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7593 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7594
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007595 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7596 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7597
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007598 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7599 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7600 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7601 next servers.
7602
7603 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7604 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7605 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7606
7607 Example :
7608 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7609 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7610 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7611
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007612 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7613 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007614
7615
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007616reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7617reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007618 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7620 no | yes | yes | yes
7621 Arguments :
7622 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7623 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7624 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7625 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7626 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7627 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7628 case.
7629
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007630 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7631 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7632
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007633 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7634 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7635 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7636 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007637 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007638
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007639 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007640 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007641 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007642
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007643 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7644 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7645
7646 Example :
7647 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7648 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7649 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7650
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007651 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7652 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007653
7654
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007655reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7656reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007657 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7659 no | yes | yes | yes
7660 Arguments :
7661 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7662 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7663 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7664 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7665 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7666 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7667 case.
7668
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007669 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7670 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7671
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007672 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7673 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7674 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7675 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7676
7677 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7678 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7679
7680 Example :
7681 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7682 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7683 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7684 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7685
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007686 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7687 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007688
7689
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007690reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7691reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007692 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7694 no | yes | yes | yes
7695 Arguments :
7696 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7697 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7698 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7699 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7700 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7701 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7702
7703 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7704 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7705 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7706 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007707 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007708
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007709 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7710 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7711
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007712 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7713 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7714 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7715
7716 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7717 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7718 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7719 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7720 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7721
7722 Example :
7723 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007724 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007725 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7726 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7727
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007728 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7729 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007730
7731
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007732reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7733reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007734 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7736 no | yes | yes | yes
7737 Arguments :
7738 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7739 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7740 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7741 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7742 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7743 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7744 ignores case.
7745
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007746 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7747 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7748
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007749 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7750 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007751 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7752 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7753 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007754 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7755 not set.
7756
7757 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7758 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7759 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7760 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7761 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7762
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007763 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007764 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007765 # block all others.
7766 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7767 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7768
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007769 # block bad guys
7770 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7771 reqitarpit . if badguys
7772
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007773 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7774 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007775
7776
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007777retries <value>
7778 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7780 yes | no | yes | yes
7781 Arguments :
7782 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7783 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7784 default value is 3.
7785
7786 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7787 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7788 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7789
7790 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007791 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7792 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007793
7794 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7795 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7796
7797 See also : "option redispatch"
7798
7799
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007800rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007801 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7803 no | yes | yes | yes
7804 Arguments :
7805 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7806 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007807 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007808
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007809 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7810 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7811
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007812 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7813 the last header of an HTTP response.
7814
7815 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7816 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7817 responses.
7818
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007819 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7820 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007821
7822
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007823rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7824rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007825 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7827 no | yes | yes | yes
7828 Arguments :
7829 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7830 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7831 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7832 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7833 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7834 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7835 ignores case.
7836
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007837 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7838 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7839
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007840 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7841 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007842 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007843 client.
7844
7845 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7846 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7847 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7848
7849 Example :
7850 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007851 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007852
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007853 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7854 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007855
7856
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007857rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7858rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007859 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7861 no | yes | yes | yes
7862 Arguments :
7863 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7864 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7865 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7866 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7867 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7868 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7869 ignores case.
7870
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007871 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7872 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7873
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007874 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7875 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7876 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7877 case-sensitive.
7878
7879 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007880 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7881 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7882 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007883
7884 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7885 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7886
7887 Example :
7888 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7889 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7890
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007891 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7892 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007893
7894
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007895rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7896rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007897 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7899 no | yes | yes | yes
7900 Arguments :
7901 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7902 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7903 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7904 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7905 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7906 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7907 ignores case.
7908
7909 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7910 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7911 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7912 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007913 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007914
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007915 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7916 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7917
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007918 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7919 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7920 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7921
7922 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7923 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7924 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7925 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7926 are not case-sensitive.
7927
7928 Example :
7929 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7930 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7931
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007932 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7933 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007934
7935
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007936server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007937 Declare a server in a backend
7938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7939 no | no | yes | yes
7940 Arguments :
7941 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007942 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007943 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007944
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007945 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7946 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7947 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7948 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007949 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7950 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7951 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7952 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7953 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007954 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7955 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7956 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7957 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7958 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7959 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7960 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007961 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007962 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7963 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7964 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7965 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7966 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7967 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007968 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7969 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007970 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7971 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007972
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007973 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007974 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7975 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7976 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7977 adding this value to the client's port.
7978
7979 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7980 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007981 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007982
7983 Examples :
7984 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7985 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007986 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007987 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7988 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7989 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007990
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007991 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7992 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7993 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7994 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7995 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7996
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007997 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7998 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007999
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008000server-state-file-name [<file>]
8001 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8002 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8003 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8004 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8005 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8006 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8007
8008 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8009 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8010
8011 global
8012 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8013
8014 backend bk
8015 load-server-state-from-file
8016
8017 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8018 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008019
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008020server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8021 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8022 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8024 no | no | yes | yes
8025
8026 Arguments:
8027 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8028
8029 <num | range>
8030 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8031 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8032 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8033 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8034
8035 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8036
8037 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8038
8039 <params*>
8040 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8041 keyword.
8042
8043 Examples:
8044 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8045 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8046 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8047
8048 # or
8049 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8050
8051 # would be equivalent to:
8052 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8053 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8054 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8055
8056
8057
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008058source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008059source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008060source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008061 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8063 yes | no | yes | yes
8064 Arguments :
8065 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8066 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008067
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008068 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008069 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8070 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8071 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8072 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8073 supported prefixes are :
8074 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8075 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8076 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008077 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008078 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8079 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008080
8081 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8082 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008083 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8084 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8085 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008086
8087 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8088 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8089 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8090 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8091 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8092 <addr>.
8093
8094 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8095 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8096 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8097 port.
8098
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008099 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8100 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8101 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8102 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008103 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008104 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8105 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8106 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8107 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8108 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8109 HTTP header.
8110
8111 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8112 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008113 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008114 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8115 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8116 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8117 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8118 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8119 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8120 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8121
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008122 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8123 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8124 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8125 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8126 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8127 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8128
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008129 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8130 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8131 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8132 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8133
8134 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8135 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8136 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8137 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8138 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8139 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8140
8141 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8142 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8143 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8144 there are two methods :
8145
8146 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8147 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8148 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8149 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8150 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8151 of the client ranges may be used.
8152
8153 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8154 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8155 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8156 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8157 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8158 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8159 same session.
8160
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008161 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8162 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8163 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008164 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008165
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008166 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8167
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008168 Examples :
8169 backend private
8170 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8171 source 192.168.1.200
8172
8173 backend transparent_ssl1
8174 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8175 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8176
8177 backend transparent_ssl2
8178 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8179 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8180 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8181
8182 backend transparent_ssl3
8183 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8184 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8185 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8186
8187 backend transparent_smtp
8188 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8189 # with Tproxy version 4.
8190 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8191
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008192 backend transparent_http
8193 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8194 # proxy.
8195 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008197 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008198 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8199
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008200
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008201srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8202 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8204 yes | no | yes | yes
8205 Arguments :
8206 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8207 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8208 as explained at the top of this document.
8209
8210 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8211 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8212 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8213 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8214 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8215 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8216 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8217
8218 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8219 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8220 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8221 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8222 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008223 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008224 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008225 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008226
8227 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8228 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8229 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8230 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8231 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8232 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8233
8234 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8235 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8236
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008237 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8238 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008239
8240
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008241stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8242 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008244 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008245
8246 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8247 matched.
8248
8249 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8250 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8251
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008252 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8253 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008254 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008255
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008256 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8257 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8258 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8259 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008260
8261 Example :
8262 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8263 backend stats_localhost
8264 stats enable
8265 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8266
8267 Example :
8268 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8269 backend stats_auth
8270 stats enable
8271 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8272 stats admin if TRUE
8273
8274 Example :
8275 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8276 userlist stats-auth
8277 group admin users admin
8278 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8279 group readonly users haproxy
8280 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8281
8282 backend stats_auth
8283 stats enable
8284 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8285 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8286 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8287 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8288
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008289 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8290 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8291 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008292
8293
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008294stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8295 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008297 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008298 Arguments :
8299 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8300
8301 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8302
8303 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8304 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8305 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8306 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8307 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8308 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8309
8310 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8311 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8312 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008313 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008314
8315 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8316 report using "stats scope".
8317
8318 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8319 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8320 unobvious parameters.
8321
8322 Example :
8323 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8324 backend public_www
8325 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8326 stats enable
8327 stats hide-version
8328 stats scope .
8329 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008330 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008331 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8332 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8333
8334 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8335 backend private_monitoring
8336 stats enable
8337 stats uri /admin?stats
8338 stats refresh 5s
8339
8340 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8341
8342
8343stats enable
8344 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008346 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008347 Arguments : none
8348
8349 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8350 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8351 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8352 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8353 - stats auth : no authentication
8354 - stats scope : no restriction
8355
8356 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8357 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8358 unobvious parameters.
8359
8360 Example :
8361 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8362 backend public_www
8363 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8364 stats enable
8365 stats hide-version
8366 stats scope .
8367 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008368 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008369 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8370 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8371
8372 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8373 backend private_monitoring
8374 stats enable
8375 stats uri /admin?stats
8376 stats refresh 5s
8377
8378 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8379
8380
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008381stats hide-version
8382 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008384 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008385 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008386
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008387 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8388 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8389 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8390 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8391 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8392 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008394 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8395 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8396 unobvious parameters.
8397
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008398 Example :
8399 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8400 backend public_www
8401 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008402 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008403 stats hide-version
8404 stats scope .
8405 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008406 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008407 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8408 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008409
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008410 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8411 backend private_monitoring
8412 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008413 stats uri /admin?stats
8414 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008415
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008416 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008417
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008418
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008419stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8420 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8421 Access control for statistics
8422
8423 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8424 no | no | yes | yes
8425
8426 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8427 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8428 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8429 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8430 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8431 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8432
8433 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8434 instance.
8435
8436 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8437 about ACL usage.
8438
8439
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008440stats realm <realm>
8441 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008443 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008444 Arguments :
8445 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8446 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8447 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8448
8449 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8450 using a backslash ('\').
8451
8452 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8453 only related to authentication.
8454
8455 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8456 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8457 unobvious parameters.
8458
8459 Example :
8460 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8461 backend public_www
8462 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8463 stats enable
8464 stats hide-version
8465 stats scope .
8466 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008467 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008468 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8469 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8470
8471 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8472 backend private_monitoring
8473 stats enable
8474 stats uri /admin?stats
8475 stats refresh 5s
8476
8477 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8478
8479
8480stats refresh <delay>
8481 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008483 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008484 Arguments :
8485 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8486 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8487 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8488 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8489 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8490 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8491
8492 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8493 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8494 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8495 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8496
8497 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8498 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8499 unobvious parameters.
8500
8501 Example :
8502 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8503 backend public_www
8504 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8505 stats enable
8506 stats hide-version
8507 stats scope .
8508 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008509 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008510 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8511 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8512
8513 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8514 backend private_monitoring
8515 stats enable
8516 stats uri /admin?stats
8517 stats refresh 5s
8518
8519 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8520
8521
8522stats scope { <name> | "." }
8523 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008525 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008526 Arguments :
8527 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8528 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8529 section in which the statement appears.
8530
8531 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8532 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8533 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8534 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8535 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8536 exists.
8537
8538 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8539 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8540 unobvious parameters.
8541
8542 Example :
8543 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8544 backend public_www
8545 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8546 stats enable
8547 stats hide-version
8548 stats scope .
8549 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008550 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008551 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8552 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8553
8554 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8555 backend private_monitoring
8556 stats enable
8557 stats uri /admin?stats
8558 stats refresh 5s
8559
8560 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8561
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008562
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008563stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008564 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008566 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008567
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008568 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008569 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8570
8571 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8572 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8573
8574 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8575 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008576 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008577
8578 Example :
8579 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8580 backend private_monitoring
8581 stats enable
8582 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8583 stats uri /admin?stats
8584 stats refresh 5s
8585
8586 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8587 global section.
8588
8589
8590stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008591 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8593 yes | yes | yes | yes
8594 Arguments : none
8595
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008596 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008597 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8598 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8599 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8600 - IP (socket, server)
8601 - cookie (backend, server)
8602
8603 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8604 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008605 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008606
8607 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8608
8609
8610stats show-node [ <name> ]
8611 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008613 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008614 Arguments:
8615 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8616 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8617
8618 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8619 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008620 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008621
8622 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8623 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8624 unobvious parameters.
8625
8626 Example:
8627 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8628 backend private_monitoring
8629 stats enable
8630 stats show-node Europe-1
8631 stats uri /admin?stats
8632 stats refresh 5s
8633
8634 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8635 section.
8636
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008637
8638stats uri <prefix>
8639 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008641 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008642 Arguments :
8643 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8644 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8645 query string.
8646
8647 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8648 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8649 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8650 possible to reach it in the application.
8651
8652 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008653 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008654 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8655 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8656 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8657 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8658
8659 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8660 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8661 an address or a port to statistics only.
8662
8663 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8664 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8665 unobvious parameters.
8666
8667 Example :
8668 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8669 backend public_www
8670 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8671 stats enable
8672 stats hide-version
8673 stats scope .
8674 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008675 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008676 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8677 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8678
8679 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8680 backend private_monitoring
8681 stats enable
8682 stats uri /admin?stats
8683 stats refresh 5s
8684
8685 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8686
8687
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008688stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8689 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008691 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008692
8693 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008694 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008695 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008696 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008697 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8698
8699 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8700 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8701 the "stick-table" statement.
8702
8703 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8704 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8705 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8706 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8707 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8708
8709 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8710 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8711 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8712 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8713 transformation rules.
8714
8715 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8716 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8717 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8718 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8719 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8720 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8721 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8722
8723 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8724 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8725 ACL based conditions.
8726
8727 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8728 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8729 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8730 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8731
8732 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8733 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8734 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8735 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8736
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008737 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8738 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008739 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008740
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008741 Example :
8742 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8743 # last 30 minutes
8744 backend pop
8745 mode tcp
8746 balance roundrobin
8747 stick store-request src
8748 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8749 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8750 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8751
8752 backend smtp
8753 mode tcp
8754 balance roundrobin
8755 stick match src table pop
8756 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8757 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8758
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008759 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008760 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008761
8762
8763stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8764 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8766 no | no | yes | yes
8767
8768 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8769 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8770 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8771 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8772
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008773 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8774 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008775 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008776
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008777 Examples :
8778 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008779 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008780
8781 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8782 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8783 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8784
8785
8786 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8787 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8788 backend http
8789 mode http
8790 balance roundrobin
8791 stick on src table https
8792 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8793 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8794 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8795
8796 backend https
8797 mode tcp
8798 balance roundrobin
8799 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8800 stick on src
8801 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8802 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8803
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008804 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008805
8806
8807stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8808 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8810 no | no | yes | yes
8811
8812 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008813 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008814 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008815 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008816 server is selected.
8817
8818 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8819 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8820 the "stick-table" statement.
8821
8822 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8823 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8824 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8825 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8826 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8827 address.
8828
8829 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8830 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8831 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8832 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8833 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8834 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8835 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8836 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8837 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8838 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8839
8840 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8841 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8842 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8843 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8844 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8845 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8846 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8847
8848 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8849 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8850 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8851 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8852
8853 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8854 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8855 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8856 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8857 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8858 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008859 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8860 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8861 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8862 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8863 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8864 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008865
8866 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8867 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8868 the request.
8869
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008870 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8871 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008872 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008873
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008874 Example :
8875 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8876 # last 30 minutes
8877 backend pop
8878 mode tcp
8879 balance roundrobin
8880 stick store-request src
8881 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8882 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8883 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8884
8885 backend smtp
8886 mode tcp
8887 balance roundrobin
8888 stick match src table pop
8889 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8890 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8891
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008892 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008893 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008894
8895
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008896stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008897 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8898 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008899 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008901 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008902
8903 Arguments :
8904 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8905 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8906 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8907 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8908
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008909 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8910 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8911 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8912 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8913
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008914 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8915 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8916 instance.
8917
8918 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8919 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8920 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8921 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8922 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8923 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008924 to 32 characters.
8925
8926 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8927 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8928 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008929 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008930 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8931 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008932
8933 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008934 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8935 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008936 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8937 increase.
8938
8939 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008940 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8941 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8942 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008943
8944 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8945 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8946 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8947 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008948 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008949 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8950 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8951 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8952 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8953 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8954 parameter (see below).
8955
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008956 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8957 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8958 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8959 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8960 soft restart.
8961
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008962 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8963 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008964
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008965 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8966 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8967 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8968 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008969 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008970 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008971 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8972 if not expiration delay is specified.
8973
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008974 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8975 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8976 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8977 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008978 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8979 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8980 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8981 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8982 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8983 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8984 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8985 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8986 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8987 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8988 types and their arguments.
8989
8990 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8991 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8992 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8993 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8994
8995 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8996 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8997 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008998 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008999
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009000 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9001 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9002 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009003 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009004 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009005 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009006
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009007 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9008 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9009 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9010 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9011
9012 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9013 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9014 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9015 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9016 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9017 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9018
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009019 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9020 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9021 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9022 they were received.
9023
9024 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9025 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9026 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9027 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9028 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9029
9030 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9031 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9032 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9033 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9034 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9035
9036 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9037 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9038 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9039
9040 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9041 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9042 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9043 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9044 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9045
9046 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9047 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9048 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9049 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9050 the client side.
9051
9052 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9053 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9054 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9055 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9056 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9057 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9058 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9059
9060 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9061 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9062 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9063 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9064 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9065 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009066 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009067
9068 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9069 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9070 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9071 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9072 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9073 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9074
9075 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009076 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009077 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9078 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9079
9080 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9081 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9082 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9083 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9084 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9085 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9086 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9087 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9088 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9089 recommended for better fairness.
9090
9091 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009092 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009093 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9094 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9095
9096 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9097 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9098 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9099 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9100 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9101 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9102 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9103 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9104 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9105 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009106
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009107 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9108 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009109 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9110 reference it.
9111
9112 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9113 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009114 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9115 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9116 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009117
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009118 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9119 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9120 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9121 something that can be ignored.
9122
9123 Example:
9124 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9125 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9126 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9127 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9128
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009129 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009130 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009131
9132
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009133stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009134 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9136 no | no | yes | yes
9137
9138 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009139 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009140 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009141 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009142 server is selected.
9143
9144 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9145 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9146 the "stick-table" statement.
9147
9148 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9149 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9150 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9151 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9152
9153 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9154 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9155 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9156 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9157 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9158 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009159 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009160 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9161 rules.
9162
9163 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9164 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9165 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9166 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9167 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9168 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9169 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9170
9171 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9172 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9173 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9174 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9175
9176 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9177 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9178 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9179 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9180 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9181 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009182 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9183 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9184 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9185 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9186 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9187 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9188 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9189 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9190 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009191
9192 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9193
9194 Example :
9195 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9196 backend https
9197 mode tcp
9198 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009199 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009200 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009201
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009202 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9203 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9204
9205 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9206 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9207 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9208
9209 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9210 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009211
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009212 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9213 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9214 # at offset 44.
9215
9216 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9217 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9218
9219 # Learn on response if server hello.
9220 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009221
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009222 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9223 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9224
9225 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9226 extraction.
9227
9228
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009229tcp-check connect [params*]
9230 Opens a new connection
9231 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9232 no | no | yes | yes
9233
9234 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9235 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9236 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9237
9238 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9239 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9240 of the sequence.
9241
9242 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9243 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9244 do.
9245
9246 Parameters :
9247 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9248 use the TCP connection.
9249
9250 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9251 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9252 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9253
9254 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9255
9256 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9257
9258 Examples:
9259 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9260 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9261 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9262 option tcp-check
9263 tcp-check connect
9264 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9265 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9266 tcp-check send \r\n
9267 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9268 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9269 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9270 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9271 tcp-check send \r\n
9272 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9273 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9274
9275 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9276 option tcp-check
9277 tcp-check connect port 110
9278 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9279 tcp-check connect port 143
9280 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9281 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9282
9283 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9284
9285
9286tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009287 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009288 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9289 no | no | yes | yes
9290
9291 Arguments :
9292 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9293 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9294 binary.
9295 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9296 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9297 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9298
9299 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9300 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9301 with the usual backslash ('\').
9302 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009303 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009304 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9305 used upper or lower case.
9306
9307
9308 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9309
9310 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9311 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9312 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9313 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9314 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9315 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9316 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9317 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9318
9319 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9320 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9321 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9322 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9323 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9324 expression.
9325
9326 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9327 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9328 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9329 this exact hexadecimal string.
9330 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9331
9332 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9333 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9334 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9335 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9336 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9337 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9338 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9339 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9340 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9341 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9342 the null character.
9343
9344 Examples :
9345 # perform a POP check
9346 option tcp-check
9347 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9348
9349 # perform an IMAP check
9350 option tcp-check
9351 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9352
9353 # look for the redis master server
9354 option tcp-check
9355 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009356 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009357 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9358 tcp-check expect string role:master
9359 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9360 tcp-check expect string +OK
9361
9362
9363 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9364 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9365
9366
9367tcp-check send <data>
9368 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9369 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9370 no | no | yes | yes
9371
9372 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9373 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9374
9375 Examples :
9376 # look for the redis master server
9377 option tcp-check
9378 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9379 tcp-check expect string role:master
9380
9381 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9382 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9383
9384
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009385tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9386 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009387 tcp health check
9388 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9389 no | no | yes | yes
9390
9391 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9392 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009393 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009394 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9395 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9396 hexadecimal string.
9397 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9398
9399 Examples :
9400 # redis check in binary
9401 option tcp-check
9402 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9403 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9404
9405
9406 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9407 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9408
9409
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009410tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9411 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9413 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009414 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009415 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9416 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009417
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009418 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009419
9420 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9421 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009422 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9423 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9424 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9425 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9426 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9427 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009428
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009429 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9430 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9431 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9432 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009433
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009434 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009435 - accept :
9436 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9437 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9438 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009439
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009440 - reject :
9441 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9442 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9443 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9444 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9445 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9446 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9447 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9448 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9449 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9450 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9451 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009452 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009453
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009454 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9455 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9456 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9457 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9458 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9459 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9460 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9461 hosts.
9462
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009463 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9464 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9465 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9466 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9467 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9468 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9469 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9470 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9471
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009472 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9473 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9474 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9475 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9476 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9477 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9478 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9479 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9480 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009481 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9482 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009483
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009484 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009485 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009486 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9487 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9488 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9489 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9490 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9491 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9492 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9493 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9494 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9495 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9496 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9497 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009499 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009500 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009501 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009502 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009503 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9504 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9505 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009506
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009507 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9508 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9509 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9510 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009512 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9513 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9514 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9515 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9516 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009517 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9518 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9519 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9520 layer7 information is extracted.
9521
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009522 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9523 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9524 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9525 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9526 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009527
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009528 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9529 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9530 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9531 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9532
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009533 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9534 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9535 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9536 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9537
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009538 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9539 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9540 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9541 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9542 continues.
9543
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009544 - set-src <expr> :
9545 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9546 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9547 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009548 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009549
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009550 Arguments:
9551 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9552 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009553
9554 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009555 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9556
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009557 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9558 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009559
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009560 - set-src-port <expr> :
9561 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9562 expression.
9563
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009564 Arguments:
9565 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9566 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009567
9568 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009569 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9570
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009571 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9572 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9573 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009574
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009575 - set-dst <expr> :
9576 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9577 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9578 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9579 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9580 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9581
9582 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9583 followed by some converters.
9584
9585 Example:
9586
9587 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9588 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9589
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009590 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9591 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9592
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009593 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9594 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9595 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9596 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9597
9598
9599 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9600 followed by some converters.
9601
9602 Example:
9603
9604 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9605
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009606 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9607 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9608 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9609
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009610 - "silent-drop" :
9611 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009612 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009613 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9614 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9615 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9616 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9617 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009618 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9619 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009620 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9621 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009622 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009623 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9624 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9625 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9626 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9627
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009628 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9629 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9630 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009631
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009632 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9633 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9634 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009636 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009637 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009638 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009639
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009640 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9641 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9642 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009643
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009644 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009645 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9646 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009647
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009648 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9649
9650 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9651
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009652 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9653
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009654 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009655
9656
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009657tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9658 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009660 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009661 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009662 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9663 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009664
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009665 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009666
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009667 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009668 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9669 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9670 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9671 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009672
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009673 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9674 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9675 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9676 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009677 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9678 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9679 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9680 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9681 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9682 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009683 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009684 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009685
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009686 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9687 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9688 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9689 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009690
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009691 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009692 - accept : the request is accepted
9693 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9694 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009695 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009696 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009697 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009698 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009699 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009700 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009701 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009702 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009703 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009704
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009705 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9706 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009707
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009708 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9709 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9710 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9711 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9712 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9713 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009715 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009716 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9717 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009718
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009719 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009720 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9721 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9722 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9723 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009724 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9725 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9726 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009727
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009728 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009729 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9730 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9731 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009732
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009733 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009734 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9735 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009736
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009737 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9738 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009739 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009740 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9741 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009742 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009743 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009744 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009745 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9746 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009747 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009748 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9749 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009750
9751 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9752 followed by some converters.
9753
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009754 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9755 <var-name>.
9756
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009757 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9758 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9759 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9760 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9761 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9762
9763 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9764 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9765 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9766 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9767 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9768 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9769 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9770 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9771 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9772 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9773 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9774
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009775 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9776 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9777 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9778 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9779 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9780
9781 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9782
9783 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9784
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009785 Example:
9786
9787 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009788 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009789
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009790 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009791 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9792 # and reject everything else.
9793 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9794 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009795 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009796 tcp-request content reject
9797
9798 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009799 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9800 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9801 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009802 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009803
9804 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9805 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9806 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009807 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009808 tcp-request content reject
9809
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009810 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009811 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009812 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009813 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009814 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9815 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009816
9817 Example:
9818 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9819 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009820 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009821
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009822 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009823 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009824
9825 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009826 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009827 # protecting all our sites
9828 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009829 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9830 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009831 ...
9832 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9833
9834 backend http_dynamic
9835 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009836 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009837 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009838 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009839 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009840 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009841 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009843 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009844
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009845 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9846 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009847
9848
9849tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9850 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009852 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009853 Arguments :
9854 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9855 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9856 as explained at the top of this document.
9857
9858 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9859 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9860 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9861 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9862 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9863
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009864 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9865 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9866 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9867 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9868
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009869 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9870 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009871 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009872 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009873 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9874 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9875 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9876 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009877
9878 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9879 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9880 it pass through unaffected.
9881
9882 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9883 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9884 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009885 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009886 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9887 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009888 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9889 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9890 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009891
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009892 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009893 "timeout client".
9894
9895
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009896tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9897 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9899 no | no | yes | yes
9900 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009901 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9902 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009903
9904 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9905
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009906 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009907 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9908 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009909 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9910 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009911
9912 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9913
9914 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9915 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9916 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9917 inserted.
9918
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009919 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009920 - accept :
9921 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9922 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9923 the rules evaluation.
9924
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009925 - close :
9926 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9927 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9928 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9929 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9930 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9931 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009932 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009933 protocols.
9934
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009935 - reject :
9936 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9937 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009938 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009939
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009940 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9941 Sets a variable.
9942
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009943 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9944 Unsets a variable.
9945
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009946 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9947 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9948 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9949 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9950
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009951 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9952 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9953 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9954 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9955
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009956 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9957 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9958 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9959 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9960 continues.
9961
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009962 - "silent-drop" :
9963 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009964 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009965 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9966 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9967 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9968 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9969 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009970 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9971 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009972 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9973 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009974 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009975 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9976 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9977 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9978 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9979
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009980 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9981 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9982
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009983 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9984 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9985 for changing the default action to a reject.
9986
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009987 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9988 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9989 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9990 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009991 period.
9992
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009993 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9994 declared inline.
9995
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009996 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9997 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009998 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009999 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10000 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010001 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010002 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010003 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010004 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10005 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010006 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010007 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10008 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010009
10010 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10011 followed by some converters.
10012
10013 Example:
10014
10015 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10016
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010017 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10018 <var-name>.
10019
10020 Example:
10021
10022 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10023
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010024 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10025 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10026 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10027 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10028 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10029
10030 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10031
10032 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10033
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010034 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10035
10036 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10037
10038
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010039tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10040 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10042 no | yes | yes | no
10043 Arguments :
10044 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10045 below.
10046
10047 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10048
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010049 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010050 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10051 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10052 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10053 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10054 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10055 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10056 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010057 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010058 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10059 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10060 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10061 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10062 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10063 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10064 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10065 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10066 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10067 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10068 instead.
10069
10070 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10071 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10072 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10073 rules which may be inserted.
10074
10075 Several types of actions are supported :
10076 - accept : the request is accepted
10077 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10078 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10079 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010080 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010081 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10082 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010083 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010084 - silent-drop
10085
10086 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10087 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10088 sections for a complete description.
10089
10090 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10091 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10092 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10093
10094 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10095 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10096 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10097 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10098 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10099
10100 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10101 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10102
10103 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10104 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10105 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10106
10107 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10108 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10109 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10110
10111 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10112 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10113 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10114
10115 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10116 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10117 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10118
10119 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10120
10121 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10122
10123
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010124tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10125 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10127 no | no | yes | yes
10128 Arguments :
10129 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10130 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10131 as explained at the top of this document.
10132
10133 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10134
10135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010136timeout check <timeout>
10137 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10138 established.
10139
10140 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10141 yes | no | yes | yes
10142 Arguments:
10143 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10144 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10145 as explained at the top of this document.
10146
10147 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10148 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010149 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010150 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010151 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10152 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10153 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010154
10155 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10156 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10157
10158 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10159 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010160 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010161
10162 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10163 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10164 forget about it.
10165
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010166 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10167 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010168
10169
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010170timeout client <timeout>
10171timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10172 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10174 yes | yes | yes | no
10175 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010176 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010177 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10178 as explained at the top of this document.
10179
10180 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10181 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10182 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010183 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10184 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10185 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10186 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010187 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10188 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10189 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010190 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010191 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010192 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10193 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010194 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10195 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010196
10197 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10198 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10199 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10200 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10201 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10202 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010204 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010206 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10207 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10208 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10209
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010210 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10211 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010212
10213
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010214timeout client-fin <timeout>
10215 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10217 yes | yes | yes | no
10218 Arguments :
10219 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10220 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10221 as explained at the top of this document.
10222
10223 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10224 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10225 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10226 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10227 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10228 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10229 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010230 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10231 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10232 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010233
10234 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10235 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10236 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10237
10238 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10239
10240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010241timeout connect <timeout>
10242timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10243 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10245 yes | no | yes | yes
10246 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010247 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010248 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10249 as explained at the top of this document.
10250
10251 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010252 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010253 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010254 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010255 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10256 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010257
10258 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10259 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10260 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10261 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10262 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10263 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10264
10265 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10266 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10267 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10268
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010269 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10270 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010271
10272
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010273timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10274 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10276 yes | yes | yes | yes
10277 Arguments :
10278 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10279 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10280 as explained at the top of this document.
10281
10282 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10283 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10284 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10285 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10286 once the request has started to present itself.
10287
10288 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10289 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10290 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10291 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10292 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10293
10294 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10295 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10296 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10297 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10298
10299 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10300 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010301 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010302 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10303 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010304 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010305
10306 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10307 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10308 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10309 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10310
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010311 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10312 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010313 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10314
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010315 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10316
10317
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010318timeout http-request <timeout>
10319 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010321 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010322 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010323 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10325 as explained at the top of this document.
10326
10327 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10328 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10329 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10330 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10331 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10332 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10333 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010334 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10335 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10336 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10337 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010338 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010339 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10340 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010341
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010342 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10343 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10344 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10345 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10346 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010347 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010348
10349 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10350 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010351 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010352 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10353 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10354
10355 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010356 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10357 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10358 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010359
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010360 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010361 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010362
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010363
10364timeout queue <timeout>
10365 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10367 yes | no | yes | yes
10368 Arguments :
10369 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10370 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10371 as explained at the top of this document.
10372
10373 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10374 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10375 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10376 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10377 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10378
10379 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10380 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10381 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10382 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10383
10384 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10385
10386
10387timeout server <timeout>
10388timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10389 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10391 yes | no | yes | yes
10392 Arguments :
10393 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10394 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10395 as explained at the top of this document.
10396
10397 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10398 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10399 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10400 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10401 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10402 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10403 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10404
10405 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10406 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10407 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10408 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10409 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010410 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010411 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010412 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10413 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010414 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10415 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010416
10417 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10418 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10419 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10420 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10421 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10422 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10423
10424 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10425 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10426 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10427
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010428 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010429
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010430
10431timeout server-fin <timeout>
10432 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10434 yes | no | yes | yes
10435 Arguments :
10436 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10437 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10438 as explained at the top of this document.
10439
10440 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10441 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10442 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10443 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10444 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10445 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10446 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10447 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10448 situations, it should not be needed.
10449
10450 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10451 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10452 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10453
10454 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10455
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010456
10457timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010458 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10460 yes | yes | yes | yes
10461 Arguments :
10462 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10463 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10464 as explained at the top of this document.
10465
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010466 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10467 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10468 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10469 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010470
10471 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10472 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10473 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10474 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010475 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010476
10477 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10478
10479
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010480timeout tunnel <timeout>
10481 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10483 yes | no | yes | yes
10484 Arguments :
10485 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10486 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10487 as explained at the top of this document.
10488
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010489 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010490 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10491 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10492 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010493 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10494 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010495 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10496 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10497 specified.
10498
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010499 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10500 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10501 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10502 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10503 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10504 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10505 state.
10506
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010507 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10508 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10509 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10510 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010511 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010512
10513 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10514 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10515 forget about it.
10516
10517 Example :
10518 defaults http
10519 option http-server-close
10520 timeout connect 5s
10521 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010522 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010523 timeout server 30s
10524 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10525
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010526 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010527
10528
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010529transparent (deprecated)
10530 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010532 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010533 Arguments : none
10534
10535 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10536 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10537 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10538 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10539 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10540 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10541 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10542 appropriate server.
10543
10544 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10545
10546 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10547 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10548
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010549 See also: "option transparent"
10550
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010551unique-id-format <string>
10552 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10554 yes | yes | yes | no
10555 Arguments :
10556 <string> is a log-format string.
10557
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010558 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10559 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10560 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10561 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010562
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010563 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10564 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10565 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10566 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10567 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10568 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10569 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10570 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010571
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010572 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10573 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010574
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010575 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010576
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010577 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010578
10579 will generate:
10580
10581 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10582
10583 See also: "unique-id-header"
10584
10585unique-id-header <name>
10586 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10588 yes | yes | yes | no
10589 Arguments :
10590 <name> is the name of the header.
10591
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010592 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10593 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010594
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010595 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010596
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010597 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010598 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10599
10600 will generate:
10601
10602 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10603
10604 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010605
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010606use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010607 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10609 no | yes | yes | no
10610 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010611 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10612 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010613
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010614 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10615 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010616
10617 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10618 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10619 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010620 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010621 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010622 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10623 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010624
10625 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10626 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10627 assign the backend.
10628
10629 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10630 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10631 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10632 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10633 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10634 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10635
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010636 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010637 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010638 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10639 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10640 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10641
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010642 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10643 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10644 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10645 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10646 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10647 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10648 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10649 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10650 cannot be forced from the request.
10651
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010652 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010653 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10654 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10655
10656 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10657 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010658
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010659
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010660use-server <server> if <condition>
10661use-server <server> unless <condition>
10662 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10664 no | no | yes | yes
10665 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010666 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010667
10668 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10669
10670 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10671 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10672 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10673
10674 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10675 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10676 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10677 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10678 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10679 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10680 matches will assign the server.
10681
10682 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10683 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10684 with the next rules until one matches.
10685
10686 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10687 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10688 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10689 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10690
10691 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10692 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10693 stripped.
10694
10695 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10696 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10697 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10698 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10699
10700 Example :
10701 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10702 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10703 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10704 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10705 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10706 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010707 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010708 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10709 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10710
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010711 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010712
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010713
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107145. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010715--------------------------
10716
10717The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10718depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10719settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10720written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10721described in this section.
10722
10723
107245.1. Bind options
10725-----------------
10726
10727The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10728as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10729no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10730parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10731while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10732provided immediately after the setting name.
10733
10734The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10735
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010736accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10737 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10738 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10739 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10740 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10741 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10742 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10743 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10744 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10745 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010746 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10747 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10748 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010749
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010750accept-proxy
10751 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010752 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10753 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010754 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10755 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10756 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10757 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010758 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010759 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10760 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010761 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10762 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010763
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010764allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010765 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010766 due to security considerations.
10767
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010768alpn <protocols>
10769 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10770 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10771 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10772 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10773 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010774 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10775 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10776 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10777 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10778 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10779 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10780 preference, like below :
10781
10782 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010783
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010784backlog <backlog>
10785 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10786 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10787
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010788curves <curves>
10789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10790 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10791 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10792 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10793 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10794 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10795
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010796ecdhe <named curve>
10797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010798 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10799 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010800
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010801ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10803 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10804 client's certificate.
10805
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010806ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10807 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10808 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10809 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10810 error is ignored.
10811
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010812ca-sign-file <cafile>
10813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10814 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10815 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10816 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10817 'generate-certificates' for details.
10818
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010819ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10821 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10822 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10823 'generate-certificates' for details.
10824
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010825ciphers <ciphers>
10826 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10827 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010828 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3. The format of the
10829 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for
10830 instance a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without
10831 quotes). Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list
10832 of suitable ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background
10833 information and recommendations see e.g.
10834 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10835 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10836 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10837
10838ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10840 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10841 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10842 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
10843 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section, and can be for instance a
10844 string such as
10845 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
10846 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
10847 the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010848
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010849crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10851 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10852 to verify client's certificate.
10853
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010854crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10856 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10857 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10858 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10859 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10860 file.
10861
10862 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10863 are loaded.
10864
10865 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010866 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010867 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10868 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10869 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10870 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010871 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10872 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010873 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010874
10875 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10876 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10877 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10878 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010879 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10880 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010881
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010882 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010883
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010884 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010885 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010886 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10887 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010888 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10889 clients).
10890
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010891 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10892 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10893 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10894 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10895 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10896 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10897 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10898 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10899 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10900 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10901 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10902 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10903 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10904
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010905 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10906 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10907 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10908 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10909 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10910
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010911 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10912 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10913 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10914 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010915
10916 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10917 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10918 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10919 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10920 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10921 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10922 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10923 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10924 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10925
10926 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10927
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010928 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010929 a cert bundle.
10930
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010931 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010932 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10933 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10934 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10935 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10936 provide multi-cert support.
10937
10938 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10939
10940 Filename | CN | SAN
10941 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10942 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010943 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010944 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10945 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10946
10947 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10948 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10949 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10950 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010951 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10952 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10953 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010954
10955 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10956 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10957
10958 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10959 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10960 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10961
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010962crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010963 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010964 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010965 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010966 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010967
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010968crt-list <file>
10969 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010970 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10971 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010972
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010973 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10974
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010975 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10976 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010977 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010978 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010979
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010980 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10981 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10982 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10983 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10984 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10985 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10986 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10987 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010988
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010989 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010990 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010991 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10992 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10993 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010994
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010995 crt-list file example:
10996 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010997 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010998 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010999 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011000
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011001defer-accept
11002 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11003 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11004 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011005 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011006 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11007 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11008 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11009 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11010 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11011 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11012 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11013
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011014expose-fd listeners
11015 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11016 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011017 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11018 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011019 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011020
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011021force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011022 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011023 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011024 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011025 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011026
11027force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011028 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011029 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011030 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011031
11032force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011033 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011034 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011035 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011036
11037force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011038 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011039 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011040 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011041
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011042force-tlsv13
11043 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11044 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011045 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011046
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011047generate-certificates
11048 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11049 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11050 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11051 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11052 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11053 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11054 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11055 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11056 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11057 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11058 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11059
11060 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11061 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011062 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011063 certificate is used many times.
11064
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011065gid <gid>
11066 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11067 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11068 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11069 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11070 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11071
11072group <group>
11073 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11074 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11075 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11076 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11077 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11078
11079id <id>
11080 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11081 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11082 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11083 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11084
11085interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011086 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11087 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11088 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11089 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11090 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11091 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011092 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11093 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11094 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11095 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11096 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11097 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011098
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011099level <level>
11100 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11101 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11102 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011103 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011104 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11105 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11106 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011107 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011108 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011109 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011110 all counters).
11111
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011112severity-output <format>
11113 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11114 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11115 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11116 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11117 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11118 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11119 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11120 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11121 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11122 rfc5424 convention.
11123
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011124maxconn <maxconn>
11125 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11126 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11127 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11128 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11129 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11130 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11131 eat all memory.
11132
11133mode <mode>
11134 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11135 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11136 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11137 UNIX sockets.
11138
11139mss <maxseg>
11140 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11141 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11142 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11143 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11144 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11145 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11146 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11147 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11148 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11149 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11150 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11151
11152name <name>
11153 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11154 page.
11155
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011156namespace <name>
11157 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11158 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11159 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11160 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11161
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011162nice <nice>
11163 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11164 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11165 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11166 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11167 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11168 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11169 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11170 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11171 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11172 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11173 one for an RDP socket.
11174
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011175no-ca-names
11176 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11177 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11178
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011179no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011180 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011181 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011182 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011183 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011184 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11185 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011186
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011187no-tls-tickets
11188 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11189 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11190 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011191 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11192 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011193
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011194no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011195 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011196 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011197 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011198 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011199 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11200 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011201
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011202no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011204 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011205 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011206 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011207 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11208 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011209
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011210no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011211 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011212 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011213 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011214 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011215 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11216 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011217
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011218no-tlsv13
11219 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11220 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11221 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11222 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011223 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11224 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011225
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011226npn <protocols>
11227 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11228 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11229 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11230 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011231 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011232 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11233 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11234 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11235 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11236 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011237
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011238prefer-client-ciphers
11239 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11240 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11241 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011242 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11243 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11244 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011245
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011246process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11247 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11248 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011249 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011250 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11251 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11252 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11253 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011254 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011255 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11256 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11257 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11258
11259 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11260
11261 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11262 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11263 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11264 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11265 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11266 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11267 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11268 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011269
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011270proto <name>
11271 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11272 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11273 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11274 in haproxy -vv.
11275 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11276 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011277 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011278 h2" on the bind line.
11279
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011280ssl
11281 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011282 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011283 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11284 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011285 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11286 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011287
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011288ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11289 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11290 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11291 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11292
11293ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11294 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11295 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11296 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11297
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011298strict-sni
11299 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11300 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11301 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11302 See the "crt" option for more information.
11303
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011304tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011305 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011306 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11307 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011308 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011309 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11310 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11311 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11312 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11313 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11314 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11315 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11316
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011317tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011318 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011319 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11320 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11321 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11322 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11323 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11324 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11325 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011326 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11327 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11328 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011329
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011330tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11331 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
11332 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
11333 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
11334 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
11335 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
11336 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
11337 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
11338 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
11339 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11340 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011342transparent
11343 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11344 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11345 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11346 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11347 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11348 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11349 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11350 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11351 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11352 so check for support with your vendor.
11353
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011354v4v6
11355 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11356 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11357 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11358 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011359 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011360
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011361v6only
11362 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11363 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11364 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011365 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11366 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011367
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011368uid <uid>
11369 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11370 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11371 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11372 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11373 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11374
11375user <user>
11376 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11377 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11378 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11379 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11380 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11381
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011382verify [none|optional|required]
11383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11384 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11385 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11386 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11387 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011388 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11389 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11390 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11391 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011392
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200113935.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011394------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011396The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11397which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11398arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11399settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11400after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11401Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11402address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011404 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011405 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011406
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011407Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11408keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011410The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011411
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011412addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011413 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011414 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11415 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11416 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11417 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11418 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011419
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011420agent-check
11421 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011422 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11423 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11424 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11425 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011426
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011427 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011428 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011429 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11430 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11431 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011432
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011433 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11434 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11435 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11436 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11437 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011438
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011439 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011440 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011441
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011442 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11443 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11444 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011445
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011446 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11447 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11448 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011449
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011450 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11451 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11452 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11453 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11454 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011455 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011456 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011457
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011458 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11459 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011460
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011461 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11462 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11463 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11464 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11465 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11466 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11467 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11468 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11469 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011470
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011471 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11472 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011473 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11474 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11475 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011476 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011477
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011478 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011479 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011480
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011481agent-send <string>
11482 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11483 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11484 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11485 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11486 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11487
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011488agent-inter <delay>
11489 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11490 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11491
11492 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11493 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11494 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11495 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11496 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11497 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11498 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11499 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11500 of backends use the same servers.
11501
11502 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11503
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011504agent-addr <addr>
11505 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11506
11507 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11508 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11509 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11510 hostname, it will be resolved.
11511
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011512agent-port <port>
11513 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11514
11515 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11516
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011517alpn <protocols>
11518 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11519 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11520 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11521 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11522 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11523 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11524 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11525 now obsolete NPN extension.
11526 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11527 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11528
11529 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011531backup
11532 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11533 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11534 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11535 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011536 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11537 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011538
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011539ca-file <cafile>
11540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11541 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11542 server's certificate.
11543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011544check
11545 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011546 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11547 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11548 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11549 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11550 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11551 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11552 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011553 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11554 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011555 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11556 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011557
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011558check-send-proxy
11559 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11560 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11561 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11562 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11563 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11564 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11565 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11566
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011567check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011568 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011569 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11570 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011571
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011572check-ssl
11573 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11574 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11575 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11576 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011577 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011578 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11579 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011580 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011581 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11582 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011583
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011584ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11586 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11587 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011588 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11589 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11590 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11591 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11592 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11593 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11594
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011595ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11597 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11598 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11599 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
11600 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section.
11601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011602cookie <value>
11603 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11604 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11605 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11606 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11607 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11608 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11609 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11610
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011611crl-file <crlfile>
11612 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11613 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11614 to verify server's certificate.
11615
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011616crt <cert>
11617 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11618 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11619 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11620 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11621 certificate request.
11622
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011623disabled
11624 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11625 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11626 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11627 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11628 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011629 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011630
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011631enabled
11632 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11633 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11634 default value.
11635 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11636 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011638error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011639 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11640 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11641 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011643 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011645fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011646 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11647 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11648 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11649
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011650force-sslv3
11651 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11652 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011653 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011654 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011655
11656force-tlsv10
11657 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011658 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011659 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011660
11661force-tlsv11
11662 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011663 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011664 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011665
11666force-tlsv12
11667 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011668 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011669 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011670
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011671force-tlsv13
11672 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11673 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011674 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011676id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011677 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11678 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11679 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011680
Olivier Houchard0c18a6f2018-12-02 14:11:41 +010011681idle-timeout <delay>
11682 Set the time to keep a connection alive before destroying it. By default
11683 connections are destroyed as soon as they are unused, if idle-timeout is
11684 non-zero, then connection are kept alive for up to <delay> before being
11685 destroyed, and can be reused if no other connection is available.
11686
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011687init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11688 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11689 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011690 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011691 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11692 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11693 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11694 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11695 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11696 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11697 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11698 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11699 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011700 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011701 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11702 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11703 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11704 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11705 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11706 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011707 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011708
11709 Example:
11710 defaults
11711 # never fail on address resolution
11712 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011714inter <delay>
11715fastinter <delay>
11716downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011717 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11718 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11719 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11720 between checks depending on the server state :
11721
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011722 Server state | Interval used
11723 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11724 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11725 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11726 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11727 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11728 or yet unchecked. |
11729 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11730 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11731 | "inter" otherwise.
11732 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011734 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11735 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11736 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11737 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011738 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11739 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11740 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11741 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11742 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011744maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011745 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11746 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11747 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11748 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11749 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11750 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11751 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11752 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011754maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011755 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11756 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11757 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11758 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11759 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11760 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11761 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011763minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011764 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11765 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11766 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11767 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11768 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11769 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011770 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011771 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011772
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011773namespace <name>
11774 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11775 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11776 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11777 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11778
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011779no-agent-check
11780 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11781 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11782 default value.
11783 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11784 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11785
11786no-backup
11787 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11788 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11789 default value.
11790 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11791 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11792
11793no-check
11794 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11795 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11796 default value.
11797 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11798 "default-server" "check" setting.
11799
11800no-check-ssl
11801 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11802 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11803 default value.
11804 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11805 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11806
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011807no-send-proxy
11808 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11809 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11810 default value.
11811 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11812 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11813
11814no-send-proxy-v2
11815 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11816 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11817 default value.
11818 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11819 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11820
11821no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11822 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11823 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11824 default value.
11825 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11826 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11827
11828no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11829 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11830 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11831 default value.
11832 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11833 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11834
11835no-ssl
11836 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11837 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11838 default value.
11839 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11840 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11841
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011842no-ssl-reuse
11843 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11844 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11845 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11846 and for paranoid users.
11847
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011848no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011849 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11850 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011851 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011852
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011853 Supported in default-server: No
11854
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011855no-tls-tickets
11856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11857 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11858 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011859 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11860 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011861 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011862
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011863no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011864 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011865 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11866 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011867 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11868 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011869 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011870
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011871 Supported in default-server: No
11872
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011873no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011874 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011875 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11876 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011877 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11878 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011879 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011880
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011881 Supported in default-server: No
11882
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011883no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011884 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011885 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11886 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011887 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11888 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011889 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011890
11891 Supported in default-server: No
11892
11893no-tlsv13
11894 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11895 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11896 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11897 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11898 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011899 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011900
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011901 Supported in default-server: No
11902
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011903no-verifyhost
11904 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11905 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11906 default value.
11907 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11908 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011909
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011910non-stick
11911 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11912 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11913 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11914
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011915npn <protocols>
11916 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11917 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11918 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11919 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11920 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11921 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11922 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011924observe <mode>
11925 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11926 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11927 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11928 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11929 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11930 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011931 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011932
11933 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011935on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011936 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11937 Currently, four modes are available:
11938 - fastinter: force fastinter
11939 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11940 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11941 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11942 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11943
11944 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11945
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011946on-marked-down <action>
11947 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11948 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011949 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11950 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11951 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11952 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11953 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11954 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11955 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11956 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011957
11958 Actions are disabled by default
11959
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011960on-marked-up <action>
11961 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11962 Currently one action is available:
11963 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11964 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11965 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11966 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011967 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11968 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011969 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11970 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11971
11972 Actions are disabled by default
11973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011974port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011975 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11976 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11977 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11978 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11979 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11980 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11981
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011982proto <name>
11983
11984 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11985 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11986 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11987 reported in haproxy -vv.
11988 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11989 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011991redir <prefix>
11992 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11993 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11994 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11995 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11996 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11997 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11998 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11999 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012000 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012001 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012002 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12003 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12004 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12005 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12006
12007 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12008
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012009rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012010 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12011 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12012 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12013
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012014resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12015 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12016 server.
12017
12018 Available options:
12019
12020 * allow-dup-ip
12021 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12022 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12023 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12024 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12025 For such case, simply enable this option.
12026 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12027
12028 * prevent-dup-ip
12029 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12030 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12031 same fqdn.
12032 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12033
12034 Example:
12035 backend b_myapp
12036 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12037 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12038 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12039
12040 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12041 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12042 it
12043 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12044 different address
12045
12046 Default value: not set
12047
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012048resolve-prefer <family>
12049 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12050 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12051 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12052 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12053
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012054 Default value: ipv6
12055
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012056 Example:
12057
12058 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012059
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012060resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12061 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12062 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012063 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012064 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12065 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012066 configured network, another address is selected.
12067
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012068 Example:
12069
12070 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012071
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012072resolvers <id>
12073 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12074 hostname.
12075
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012076 Example:
12077
12078 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012079
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012080 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012081
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012082send-proxy
12083 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12084 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12085 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12086 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012087 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12088 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12089 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12090 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12091 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12092 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12093 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12094 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12095 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12096 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012097 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12098 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012099
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012100send-proxy-v2
12101 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12102 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12103 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12104 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012105 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12106 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12107 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12108 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012109
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012110proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12111 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12112 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012113 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12114 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012115 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12116 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012117 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012118
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012119send-proxy-v2-ssl
12120 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12121 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12122 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12123 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12124 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12125 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12126 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012127 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12128 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012129
12130send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12131 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12132 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12133 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12134 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12135 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12136 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12137 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12138 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012139 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12140 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012141
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012142slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012143 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12144 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12145 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12146 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12147 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12148 parameters :
12149
12150 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12151 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12152
12153 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12154 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12155 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12156 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12157
12158 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12159 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12160 seen as failed.
12161
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012162sni <expression>
12163 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12164 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12165 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12166 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012167 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12168 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012169 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012170 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12171 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012172
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012173source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012174source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012175source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012176 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12177 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12178 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12179 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12180
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012181 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12182 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12183 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12184 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12185 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12186 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12187 server.
12188
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012189 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12190 specifying the source address without port(s).
12191
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012192ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012193 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12194 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12195 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12196 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12197 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12198 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012199 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12200 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012201
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012202ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12203 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12204 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12205 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12206
12207ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12208 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12209 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12210 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12211
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012212ssl-reuse
12213 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12214 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12215 default value.
12216 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12217 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12218
12219stick
12220 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12221 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12222 default value.
12223 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12224 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012225
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012226tcp-ut <delay>
12227 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12228 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12229 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012230 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012231 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12232 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12233 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12234 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12235 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12236 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12237 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12238 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12239 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012241track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012242 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12243 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12244 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12245 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012246 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12247
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012248tls-tickets
12249 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12250 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12251 default value.
12252 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12253 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012254
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012255verify [none|required]
12256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012257 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012258 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12259 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012260 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012261 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12262 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12263 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12264 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12265 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12266 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12267 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12268 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012269
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012270verifyhost <hostname>
12271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012272 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12273 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12274 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12275 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12276 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12277 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12278 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12279 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012281weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012282 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12283 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12284 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012285 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12286 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12287 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12288 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12289 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12290 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012291
12292
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122935.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12294-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012295
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012296HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12297using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12298configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012299This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12300can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12301workload.
12302This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12303resolution at run time.
12304Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12305carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12306
12307
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123085.3.1. Global overview
12309----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012310
12311As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12312different steps of the process life:
12313
12314 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12315 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12316 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12317
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012318 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12319 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012320
12321A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12322 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12323 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12324 resolution to know this new IP.
12325
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012326When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012327HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012328SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12329from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12330will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12331will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012332
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012333A few things important to notice:
12334 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12335 first valid response.
12336
12337 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12338 servers return an error.
12339
12340
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123415.3.2. The resolvers section
12342----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012343
12344This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012345HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12346contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012347
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012348When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12349uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12350is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12351answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12352
12353When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012354used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012355
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012356 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12357 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12358 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012359
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012360 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12361 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012362
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012363 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12364 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12365 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012366
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012367For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12368following scenarios are possible:
12369
12370 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12371 ignored
12372
12373 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12374 applied
12375
12376 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12377 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12378
12379 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12380 retries the query with a new type
12381
12382 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12383 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012384
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012385As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12386a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012387<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012388
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012389
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012390resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012391 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012392
12393A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12394
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012395accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012396 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012397 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012398 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12399 by RFC 6891)
12400
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012401 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12402
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012403nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12404 DNS server description:
12405 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12406 <ip> : IP address of the server
12407 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12408
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012409parse-resolv-conf
12410 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12411 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12412 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12413
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012414hold <status> <period>
12415 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12416 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012417 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012418 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012419 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12420 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12421 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12422
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012423 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012424
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012425resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012426 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12427 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12428 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12429
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012430resolve_retries <nb>
12431 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12432 giving up.
12433 Default value: 3
12434
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012435 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12436 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12437 type.
12438
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012439timeout <event> <time>
12440 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12441 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12442 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012443 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12444 other time applied.
12445 Default value: 1s
12446 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12447 have been received.
12448 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012449 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12450 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12451
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012452 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012453
12454 resolvers mydns
12455 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12456 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012457 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012458 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012459 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012460 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012461 hold other 30s
12462 hold refused 30s
12463 hold nx 30s
12464 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012465 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012466 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012467
12468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124696. HTTP header manipulation
12470---------------------------
12471
12472In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12473response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12474request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12475which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012476against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012477
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012478If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12479to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12480but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12481HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12482stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12483because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12484a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12485still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012487This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12488in section 4.2 :
12489
12490 - reqadd <string>
12491 - reqallow <search>
12492 - reqiallow <search>
12493 - reqdel <search>
12494 - reqidel <search>
12495 - reqdeny <search>
12496 - reqideny <search>
12497 - reqpass <search>
12498 - reqipass <search>
12499 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12500 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12501 - reqtarpit <search>
12502 - reqitarpit <search>
12503 - rspadd <string>
12504 - rspdel <search>
12505 - rspidel <search>
12506 - rspdeny <search>
12507 - rspideny <search>
12508 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12509 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12510
12511With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12512is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12513parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12514prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12515Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12516
12517 \t for a tab
12518 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12519 \n for a new line (LF)
12520 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12521 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12522 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12523 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12524 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12525
12526The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12527portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12528above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12529regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
125309 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12531is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12532
12533The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12534after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12535
12536Notes related to these keywords :
12537---------------------------------
12538 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12539 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12540 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12541
12542 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12543 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12544 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12545
12546 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12547 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12548 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12549 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12550 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12551
12552 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12553 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12554 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12555 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12556 useless headers before adding new ones.
12557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012558 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012559 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12560
12561 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12562 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12563 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12564
12565 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12566 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012567 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012568
12569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125707. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12571----------------------------------
12572
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012573HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012574client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12575The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12576these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12577but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12578data called patterns.
12579
12580
125817.1. ACL basics
12582---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012583
12584The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12585content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12586from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12587simple :
12588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012589 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012590 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012591 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12592 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012594The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12595adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012596
12597In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012599 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012600
12601This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12602Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12603and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012604an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12605conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12606as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12607are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012608
12609ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12610'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12611which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12612
12613There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12614performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012616The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12617specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12618this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012619methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12620ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012621
12622Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12623 - boolean
12624 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12625 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12626 - string
12627 - data block
12628
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012629Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12630converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12631would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12632The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12633which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12634
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012635Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12636keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12637fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12638which are summarized in the table below :
12639
12640 +---------------------+-----------------+
12641 | Sample or converter | Default |
12642 | output type | matching method |
12643 +---------------------+-----------------+
12644 | boolean | bool |
12645 +---------------------+-----------------+
12646 | integer | int |
12647 +---------------------+-----------------+
12648 | ip | ip |
12649 +---------------------+-----------------+
12650 | string | str |
12651 +---------------------+-----------------+
12652 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12653 +---------------------+-----------------+
12654
12655Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12656matching method, see below.
12657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012658The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12659 - boolean
12660 - integer or integer range
12661 - IP address / network
12662 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12663 - regular expression
12664 - hex block
12665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012666The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12667
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012668 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12669 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012670 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012671 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012672 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012673 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012674 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012676The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12677read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12678if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12679lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12680will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12681beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12682a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12683lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12684exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12685
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012686The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12687parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12688ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12689a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12690check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12691
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012692The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12693socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12694file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012696Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12697loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12698
12699 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12700
12701In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12702the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12703case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12704as well.
12705
12706The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12707sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12708do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12709methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12710is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012711obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012712followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12713default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12714that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12715string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12716
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012717The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12718By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12719string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12720resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12721server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12722waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12723flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12724function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012726There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12727sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12728be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012729
12730 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12731 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012732 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12733 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12734 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12735 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012736
12737 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12738 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012739 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012740
12741 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012742 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012743
12744 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012745 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012746
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012747 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012748 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12749
12750 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12751 binary or string samples.
12752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012753 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12754 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012756 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12757 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12758 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012760 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12761 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012763 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12764 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012766 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12767 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012769 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12770 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012771 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012773 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12774 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12775 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012776
12777For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12778request, it is possible to do :
12779
12780 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12781
12782In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12783buffer, one would use the following acl :
12784
12785 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12786
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012787On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12788possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12789
12790 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012792All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12793criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12794method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12795to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12796criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12797the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012799If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012800the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12801For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012803 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12804 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12805 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12806 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012807
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012808
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012809The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12810types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12811combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12812brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12813default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815 +-------------------------------------------------+
12816 | Input sample type |
12817 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012818 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012819 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12820 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12821 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012822 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012823 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012824 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012825 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012826 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012827 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012828 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012829 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012830 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012831 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012832 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012834 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012835 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012836 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012838 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012839 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012840 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012841 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012842 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012843 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12844 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12845 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012846
12847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128487.1.1. Matching booleans
12849------------------------
12850
12851In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12852Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12853When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12854that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12855
12856Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12857return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12858"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12859
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128617.1.2. Matching integers
12862------------------------
12863
12864Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12865enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12866to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12867
12868Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12869matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12870lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012871
12872For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12873unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12874representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12875
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012876As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12877two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12878instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12879ranges and operators.
12880
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012881For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012882operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12883Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12884of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012885
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012886Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012887
12888 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12889 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12890 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12891 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12892 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12893
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012894For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012895
12896 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12897
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012898This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12899
12900 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12901
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129037.1.3. Matching strings
12904-----------------------
12905
12906String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12907different forms :
12908
12909 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012910 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012911
12912 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012913 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012914
12915 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12916 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12917
12918 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12919 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12920
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012921 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012922 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12923 matches.
12924
12925 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12926 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12927 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012928
12929String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12930exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12931characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12932string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12933to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012934before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012935
12936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129377.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12938---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012939
12940Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12941they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12942possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12943passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12944the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012945the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12946match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012947
12948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129497.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12950-------------------------------------
12951
12952It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12953not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12954a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12955to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12956digits may be used upper or lower case.
12957
12958Example :
12959 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12960 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12961
12962
129637.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12964---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012965
12966IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12967netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12968within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012969host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012970difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12971at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12972does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12973parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012974
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012975The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12976abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12977
12978 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12979 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12980 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12981 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12982 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12983 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12984 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12985 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12986
12987Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12988192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12989
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012990IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12991Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12992trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12993IPv6 patterns.
12994
12995HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12996following situations :
12997 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12998 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12999 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13000 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13001 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13002 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13003 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13004 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13005 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13006 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013008
130097.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13010----------------------------------
13011
13012Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13013combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13014
13015 - AND (implicit)
13016 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13017 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013019A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013021 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013023Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13024indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013026For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13027"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13028requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13029is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13030
13031 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013032 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13033 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13034 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013035
13036To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13037and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13038
13039 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13040 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13041 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13042 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13043
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013044 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013045 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13046 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13047 use_backend www if host_www
13048
13049It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13050expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13051be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13052the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13053
13054 The following rule :
13055
13056 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013057 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013058
13059 Can also be written that way :
13060
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013061 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062
13063It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13064to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13065simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13066sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13067good use is the following :
13068
13069 With named ACLs :
13070
13071 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13072 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13073 monitor fail if site_dead
13074
13075 With anonymous ACLs :
13076
13077 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13078
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013079See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13080keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013081
13082
130837.3. Fetching samples
13084---------------------
13085
13086Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13087against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13088sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13089ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13090of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13091available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13092
13093This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13094Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13095compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13096deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13097
13098The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13099matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13100method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13101indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13102
13103As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13104when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13105mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13106the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13107ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13108
13109Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13110multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13111when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013112incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13113are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013114is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13115all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13116
13117Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13118 - name
13119 - name(arg1)
13120 - name(arg1,arg2)
13121
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013122
131237.3.1. Converters
13124-----------------
13125
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013126Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13127of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13128is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13129was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013130has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013131unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13132
13133These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13134sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13135the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013136support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013137
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013138A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13139support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13140supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13141(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13142bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013144The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013145
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001314651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13147 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13148 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13149 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13150 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13151 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13152
13153 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013154 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13155 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013156 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13157 frontend http-in
13158 bind *:8081
13159 default_backend servers
13160 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13161 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13162
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013163add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013164 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013165 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013166 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13167 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013168 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013169 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13170 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13171 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13172 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013173 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013174 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013175
13176and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013177 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013178 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013179 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13180 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013181 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013182 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13183 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13184 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13185 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013186 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013187 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013188
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013189b64dec
13190 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13191 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13192
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013193base64
13194 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013195 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013196 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13197
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013198bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013199 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013200 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013201 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013202 presence of a flag).
13203
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013204bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13205 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13206 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013207 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013208
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013209concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13210 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13211 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13212 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13213 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13214 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13215 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13216 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13217 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13218 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13219 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13220 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13221 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13222 delimitors.
13223
13224 Example:
13225 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13226 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13227 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13228 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13229
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013230cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013231 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13232 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013233
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013234crc32([<avalanche>])
13235 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13236 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13237 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13238 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13239 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13240 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13241 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13242 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13243 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13244 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013245 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13246
13247crc32c([<avalanche>])
13248 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13249 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13250 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13251 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13252 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13253 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13254 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13255 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013256
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013257da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013258 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13259 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13260 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13261 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013262 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013263 configuration language.
13264
13265 Example:
13266 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013267 bind *:8881
13268 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013269 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013270
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013271debug
13272 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13273 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13274 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13275
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013276div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013277 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13278 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013279 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013280 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13281 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013282 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013283 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13284 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13285 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13286 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013287 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013288 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013289
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013290djb2([<avalanche>])
13291 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13292 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13293 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13294 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13295 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13296 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13297 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013298 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13299 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013300
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013301even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013302 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013303 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13304
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013305field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13306 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13307 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13308 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13309 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13310 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13311 fields.
13312
13313 Example :
13314 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13315 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13316 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13317 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13318 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013319
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013320hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013321 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013322 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013323 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013324 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013325
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013326hex2i
13327 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13328 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13329
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013330http_date([<offset>])
13331 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13332 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13333 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13334 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13335 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13336 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013337
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013338in_table(<table>)
13339 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13340 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13341 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013342 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013343 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13344
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013345ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13346 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013347 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013348 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13349 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13350 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13351 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13352 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013353
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013354json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013355 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013356 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013357 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013358 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13359 of errors:
13360 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13361 bytes, ...)
13362 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13363 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13364
13365 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13366 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13367 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13368 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13369 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13370 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013371 - "ascii" : never fails;
13372 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13373 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013374 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013375 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013376 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13377 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13378
13379 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013380 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013381
13382 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013383 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013384 capture request header user-agent len 150
13385 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013386
13387 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13388 GET / HTTP/1.0
13389 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13390
13391 Output log:
13392 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13393
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013394language(<value>[,<default>])
13395 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13396 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13397 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13398 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13399 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13400 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13401 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13402 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13403 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013404 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013405 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13406 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013407
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013408 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013409
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013410 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13411 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013412
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013413 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13414 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13415 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13416 use_backend spanish if es
13417 use_backend french if fr
13418 use_backend english if en
13419 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013420
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013421length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013422 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13423 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13424 type. The result is of type integer.
13425
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013426lower
13427 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13428 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13429 type. The result is of type string.
13430
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013431ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13432 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13433 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13434 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13435 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13436 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13437 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13438
13439 Example :
13440
13441 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013442 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013443 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13444
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013445map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13446map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13447map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13448 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13449 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13450 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13451 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13452 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13453 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13454 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13455 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013457 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13458 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13459 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013460
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013461 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013462 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013463
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013464 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13465 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13466 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13467 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013468 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13469 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013470 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13471 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13472 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13473 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13474 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13475 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13476 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13477 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013478 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13479 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13480 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013481 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13482 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13483 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13484 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13485 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013486
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013487 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13488 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13489 the corresponding match text.
13490
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013491 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13492 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13493 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13494 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13495 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013496
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013497 Example :
13498
13499 # this is a comment and is ignored
13500 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13501 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13502 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13503 | | | `---------- value
13504 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13505 | `---------------------------- key
13506 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13507
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013508mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013509 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13510 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013511 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013512 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013513 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013514 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13515 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13516 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13517 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013518 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013519 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013520
13521mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013522 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013523 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13524 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013525 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013526 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013527 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013528 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13529 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13530 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13531 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013532 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013533 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013534
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013535nbsrv
13536 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13537 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13538 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13539 map lookup.
13540
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013541neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013542 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13543 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13544 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13545 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013546
13547not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013548 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013549 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013550 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013551 absence of a flag).
13552
13553odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013554 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013555 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13556
13557or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013558 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013559 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013560 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13561 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013562 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013563 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13564 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13565 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13566 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013567 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013568 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013569
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013570regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013571 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13572 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13573 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13574 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13575 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13576 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13577 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13578 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13579 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13580 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013581 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13582 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13583 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13584 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013585
13586 Example :
13587
13588 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13589 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13590 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13591 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13592
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013593capture-req(<id>)
13594 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13595 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13596
13597 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013598 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13599 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013600
13601capture-res(<id>)
13602 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13603 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13604
13605 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013606 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13607 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013608
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013609sdbm([<avalanche>])
13610 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13611 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13612 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13613 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13614 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13615 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13616 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013617 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13618 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013619
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013620set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013621 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13622 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13623 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013624 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013625 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13626 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013627 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013628 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13629 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013630 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013631 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013632
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013633sha1
13634 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13635 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13636
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013637strcmp(<var>)
13638 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13639 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13640 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13641 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13642 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13643 shorter).
13644
13645 Example :
13646
13647 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13648 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13649 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13650
13651
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013652sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013653 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13654 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013655 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013656 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13657 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013658 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013659 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13660 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013661 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013662 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13663 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013665 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013666
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013667table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13668 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13669 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13670 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13671 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13672 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13673 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13674
13675
13676table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13677 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13678 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13679 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13680 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13681 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13682 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13683
13684table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13685 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13686 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013687 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013688 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13689 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13690
13691table_conn_cur(<table>)
13692 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13693 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13694 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13695 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13696 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13697
13698table_conn_rate(<table>)
13699 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13700 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13701 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13702 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13703 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13704
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013705table_gpt0(<table>)
13706 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13707 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13708 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13709 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13710 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13711
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013712table_gpc0(<table>)
13713 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13714 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13715 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13716 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13717 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13718
13719table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13720 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13721 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13722 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13723 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13724 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13725 sample fetch keyword.
13726
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013727table_gpc1(<table>)
13728 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13729 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13730 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13731 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13732 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13733
13734table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13735 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13736 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13737 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13738 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13739 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13740 sample fetch keyword.
13741
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013742table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13743 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13744 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013745 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013746 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13747 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13748
13749table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13750 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13751 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13752 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13753 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13754 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13755 keyword.
13756
13757table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13758 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13759 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013760 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013761 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13762 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13763
13764table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13765 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13766 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13767 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13768 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13769 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13770 keyword.
13771
13772table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13773 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13774 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013775 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013776 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13777 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13778 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13779 keyword.
13780
13781table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13782 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13783 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013784 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013785 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13786 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13787 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13788 keyword.
13789
13790table_server_id(<table>)
13791 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13792 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13793 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13794 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13795 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13796 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13797
13798table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13799 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13800 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013801 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013802 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13803 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13804 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13805 keyword.
13806
13807table_sess_rate(<table>)
13808 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13809 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13810 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13811 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13812 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13813 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13814 keyword.
13815
13816table_trackers(<table>)
13817 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13818 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13819 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13820 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13821 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13822 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13823 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13824 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13825 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13826 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13827
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013828upper
13829 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13830 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13831 type. The result is of type string.
13832
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013833url_dec
13834 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13835 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13836
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013837unset-var(<var name>)
13838 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13839 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13840 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13841 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13842 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13843 response),
13844 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13845 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13846 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13847 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13848
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013849utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13850 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13851 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13852 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13853 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13854 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13855 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13856
13857 Example :
13858
13859 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013860 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013861 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13862
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013863word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13864 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13865 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13866 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13867 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13868 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13869
13870 Example :
13871 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13872 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13873 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13874 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13875 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013876
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013877wt6([<avalanche>])
13878 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13879 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13880 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13881 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13882 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13883 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13884 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013885 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13886 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013887
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013888xor(<value>)
13889 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013890 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013891 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013892 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013893 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013894 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13895 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013896 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013897 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13898 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013899 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013900 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013901
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013902xxh32([<seed>])
13903 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13904 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13905 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13906 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13907 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13908 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13909 as cryptographically secure.
13910
13911xxh64([<seed>])
13912 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13913 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13914 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13915 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13916 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13917 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13918 as cryptographically secure.
13919
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013920
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139217.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013922--------------------------------------------
13923
13924A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13925not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13926"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13927The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13928
13929always_false : boolean
13930 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13931 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13932
13933always_true : boolean
13934 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13935 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13936
13937avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013938 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013939 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13940 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13941 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13942 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13943 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13944 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13945 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13946 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13947 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13948 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13949 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13950 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13951 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013953be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013954 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13955 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13956 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13957 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013958 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
13959
13960be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
13961 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13962 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
13963 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
13964 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
13965 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013966 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
13967 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013968
13969 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
13970 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
13971 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013973be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13974 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13975 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13976 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013977 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013978 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13979 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013980
13981 Example :
13982 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13983 backend dynamic
13984 mode http
13985 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13986 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013987
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013988bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013989 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13990 of the string.
13991
13992bool(<bool>) : bool
13993 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13994 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013996connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13997 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013998 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013999 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14000 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014001
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014002 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014003 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014004 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14005
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014006 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14007 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014008
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014009 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014010 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014011 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014012 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014013 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014014 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014015 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014016
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014017 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14018 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014019 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014020 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014021
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014022cpu_calls : integer
14023 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14024 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14025 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14026 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14027 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14028 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14029
14030cpu_ns_avg : integer
14031 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14032 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14033 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14034 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14035 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14036 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14037 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14038 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14039 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14040 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14041 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14042
14043cpu_ns_tot : integer
14044 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14045 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14046 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14047 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14048 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14049 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14050 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14051 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14052 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14053 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14054 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14055 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14056 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14057
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014058date([<offset>]) : integer
14059 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14060 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14061 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14062 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014063 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14064
14065 Example :
14066
14067 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14068 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014069
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014070date_us : integer
14071 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14072 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14073 from the same timeval structure.
14074
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014075distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14076 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14077 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14078 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14079 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14080 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14081 list of supported tokens.
14082
14083distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14084 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14085 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14086 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14087 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14088 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14089 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14090 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14091 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14092 supported tokens.
14093
14094 Example :
14095 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14096 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14097 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14098 # send large files to the big farm
14099 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14100
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014101env(<name>) : string
14102 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14103 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14104 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14105 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14106 certain way.
14107
14108 Examples :
14109 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14110 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14111
14112 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14113 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014115fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14116 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014117 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14118 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014119 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14120 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014121 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014122 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14123 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014124
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014125fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14126 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14127 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14128 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014130fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14131 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14132 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14133 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14134 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14135 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14136 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14137 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14138 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014139
14140 Example :
14141 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14142 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14143 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14144 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14145 frontend mail
14146 bind :25
14147 mode tcp
14148 maxconn 100
14149 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14150 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14151 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14152 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014153
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014154hostname : string
14155 Returns the system hostname.
14156
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014157int(<integer>) : signed integer
14158 Returns a signed integer.
14159
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014160ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14161 Returns an ipv4.
14162
14163ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14164 Returns an ipv6.
14165
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014166lat_ns_avg : integer
14167 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14168 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14169 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14170 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14171 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14172 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14173 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14174 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14175 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14176 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14177 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14178 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14179 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14180 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14181
14182lat_ns_tot : integer
14183 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14184 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14185 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14186 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14187 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14188 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14189 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14190 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14191 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14192 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14193 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14194 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14195 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14196 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14197 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14198 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14199 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14200 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14201 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14202
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014203meth(<method>) : method
14204 Returns a method.
14205
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014206nbproc : integer
14207 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14208 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14209 and debugging purposes.
14210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014211nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14212 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14213 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14214 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014215 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14216 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14217 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014218
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014219prio_class : integer
14220 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14221 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14222 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14223
14224prio_offset : integer
14225 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14226 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14227 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14228 set-priority-offset".
14229
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014230proc : integer
14231 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14232 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14233 debugging purposes.
14234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014235queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014236 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14237 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14238 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14240 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14241 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14242 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14243 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14244
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014245rand([<range>]) : integer
14246 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14247 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14248 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14249 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14250 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014252srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14253 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14254 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14255 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14256 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14257 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014258 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14259 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14260
14261srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14262 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14263 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14264 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14265 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14266 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14267 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14268 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14269
14270 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14271 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272
14273srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14274 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14275 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14276 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014277 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14279 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14280 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14281
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014282srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14283 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14284 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14285 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14286 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14287 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14288 fetch methods.
14289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14291 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14292 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014293 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014294 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14295 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014296 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014297 overloading servers).
14298
14299 Example :
14300 # Redirect to a separate back
14301 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14302 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14303 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14304
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014305stopping : boolean
14306 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14307 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14308 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14309
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014310str(<string>) : string
14311 Returns a string.
14312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014313table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14314 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14315 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14316
14317table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14318 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14319 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14320 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14321
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014322thread : integer
14323 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14324 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14325 and debugging purposes.
14326
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014327var(<var-name>) : undefined
14328 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014329 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14330 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014331 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014332 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14333 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014334 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014335 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14336 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014337 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014338 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014339
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143407.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014341----------------------------------
14342
14343The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14344closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14345methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14346sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14347TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014348the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14349counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014350"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14351used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14352can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14353Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14354table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14355tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14356currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014357
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014358bc_http_major: integer
14359 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14360 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14361 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014363be_id : integer
14364 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14365 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14366
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014367be_name : string
14368 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14369 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371dst : ip
14372 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14373 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14374 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14375 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
14376 RFC 4291.
14377
14378dst_conn : integer
14379 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14380 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14381 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14382 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14383 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14384 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14385 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14386 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014387
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014388dst_is_local : boolean
14389 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14390 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14391 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14392 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014393 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014394 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14395 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14396 it only once per connection.
14397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398dst_port : integer
14399 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14400 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14401 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14402 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14403 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14404 an HTTP header.
14405
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014406fc_http_major : integer
14407 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14408 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14409 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14410
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014411fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14412 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14413 header.
14414
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014415fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14416 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14417 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14418 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14419 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14420 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14421 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14422
14423fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14424 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14425 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14426 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14427 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14428 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14429 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14430
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014431fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14432 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14433 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14434 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14435 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14436
14437fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14438 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14439 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14440 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14441 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14442
14443fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14444 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14445 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14446 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14447 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14448
14449fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14450 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14451 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14452 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14453 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14454
14455fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14456 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14457 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14458 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14459 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14460
14461fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14462 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14463 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14464 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14465 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14466
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014467fe_defbe : string
14468 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14469 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014471fe_id : integer
14472 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014473 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014474 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14475
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014476fe_name : string
14477 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14478 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14479 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14480
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014481sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014482sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14483sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14484sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014485 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14486 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14487 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14488
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014489sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014490sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14491sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14492sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014493 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14494 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14495 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14496
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014497sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014498sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14499sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14500sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014501 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14502 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014503 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14504 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14505 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014506
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014507 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014508 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14509 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014510 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14511 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14512 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014513 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14514 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14515
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014516sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14517sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14518sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14519sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14520 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14521 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14522 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14523 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14524 when a first ACL was verified.
14525
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014526sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014527sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14528sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14529sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014530 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014531 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14532
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014533sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014534sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14535sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14536sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014537 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14538 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14539 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14540
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014541sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014542sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14543sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14544sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014545 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14546 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14547 See also src_conn_rate.
14548
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014549sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014550sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14551sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14552sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014553 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014554 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014555
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014556sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14557sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14558sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14559sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14560 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14561 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14562
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014563sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14564sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14565sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14566sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14567 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14568 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14569
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014570sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014571sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14572sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14573sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014574 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14575 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14576 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014577 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14578 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14579 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014580
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014581sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14582sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14583sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14584sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14585 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14586 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14587 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14588 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14589 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14590 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14591
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014592sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014593sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14594sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14595sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014596 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014597 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14598 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14599
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014600sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014601sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14602sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14603sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014604 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14605 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14606 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14607 src_http_err_rate.
14608
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014609sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014610sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14611sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14612sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014613 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014614 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14615 src_http_req_cnt.
14616
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014617sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014618sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14619sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14620sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014621 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14622 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14623 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14624 src_http_req_rate.
14625
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014626sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014627sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14628sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14629sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014630 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014631 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14632 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14633 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14634 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014635
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014636 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014637 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14638 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014639 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14640
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014641sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14642sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14643sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14644sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14645 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14646 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14647 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14648 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14649 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14650
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014651sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014652sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14653sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14654sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014655 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14656 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14657 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014658
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014659sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014660sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14661sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14662sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014663 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14664 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14665 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014666
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014667sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014668sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14669sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14670sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014671 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014672 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14673 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14674 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014675 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014676 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14677
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014678sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014679sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14680sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14681sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014682 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14683 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14684 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14685 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14686 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014687 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014688
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014689sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014690sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14691sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14692sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014693 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14694 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14695 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14696
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014697sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014698sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14699sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14700sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014701 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14702 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014703 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014704 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14705 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014706 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14707 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14708 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014710so_id : integer
14711 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14712 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14713 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014715src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014716 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014717 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14718 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14719 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014720 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14721 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14722 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14723 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014724
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014725 Example:
14726 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14727 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014729src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14730 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14731 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14732 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014733 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014735src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14736 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14737 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014738 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014739 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14742 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14743 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14744 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14745 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14746 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14747 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014748
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014749 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014750 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14751 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14752 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14753 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014754 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014755 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14756 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14757
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014758src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14759 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14760 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14761 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14762 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14763 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14764 was verified.
14765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014766src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014767 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014769 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014770 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014772src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014773 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14775 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014776 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014778src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14779 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14780 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14781 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014782 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014784src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014785 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014786 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014787 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014788 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014789
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014790src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14791 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14792 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14793 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14794 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14795
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014796src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14797 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14798 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14799 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14800 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014802src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014803 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014805 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14806 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014807 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14808 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14809 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014810
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014811src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14812 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14813 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14814 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14815 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14816 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14817 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14818 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014821 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014823 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014824 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14828 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14829 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14830 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14831 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014832 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014835 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014836 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14837 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014838 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014840src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14841 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14842 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14843 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014844 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014845 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014847src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14848 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14849 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14850 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014851 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014852 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14853 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014854
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014855 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014856 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014857 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014858 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014859
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014860src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14861 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14862 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14863 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14864 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14865 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14866 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14867
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014868src_is_local : boolean
14869 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14870 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14871 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14872 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014873 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014874 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14875 once per connection.
14876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014878 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14879 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14880 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14881 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14882 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014885 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14886 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14887 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14888 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14889 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014891src_port : integer
14892 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14893 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14894 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14895 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014897src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014898 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014899 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14900 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14901 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014902 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014904src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14905 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14906 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14907 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14908 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014909 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014911src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14912 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14913 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14914 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14915 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14916 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14917 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14918 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14919 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014920
14921 Example :
14922 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14923 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14924 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14925 listen ssh
14926 bind :22
14927 mode tcp
14928 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014929 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014931 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014933srv_id : integer
14934 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14935 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14936 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014937
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200149387.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014941The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14942closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14943when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14944usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014945future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014946
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001494751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14948 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14949 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14950 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14951 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14952 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14953
14954 Example :
14955 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14956 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14957 # the request.
14958 frontend http-in
14959 bind *:8081
14960 default_backend servers
14961 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14962 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14963
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014964ssl_bc : boolean
14965 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14966 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14967 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14968
14969ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14970 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14971 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14972
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010014973ssl_bc_alpn : string
14974 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
14975 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
14976 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
14977 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14978 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14979 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
14980 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
14981 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14982 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
14983
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014984ssl_bc_cipher : string
14985 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14986 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14987
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010014988ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
14989 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14990 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
14991 session or a TLS ticket.
14992
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010014993ssl_bc_npn : string
14994 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
14995 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
14996 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
14997 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
14998 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
14999 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15000 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15001 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15002
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015003ssl_bc_protocol : string
15004 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15005 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15006
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015007ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015008 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015009 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15010 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015011
15012ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15013 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15014 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15015 if session was reused or not.
15016
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015017ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15018 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15019 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15020 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15021 BoringSSL.
15022
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015023ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15024 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15025 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15028 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15029 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15030 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15031 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15032 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015034ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15035 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15036 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15037 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15038 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015039
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015040ssl_c_der : binary
15041 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15042 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15043 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015045ssl_c_err : integer
15046 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15047 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15048 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15049 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15050 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015052ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15053 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15054 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15055 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15056 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15057 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15058 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15059 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15060 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062ssl_c_key_alg : string
15063 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15064 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15065 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015067ssl_c_notafter : string
15068 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15069 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15070 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072ssl_c_notbefore : string
15073 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15074 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15075 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15078 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15079 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15080 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15081 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15082 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15083 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15084 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15085 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087ssl_c_serial : binary
15088 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15089 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15090 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015092ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15093 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15094 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15095 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015096 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15097 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15098
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015099 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015100 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15103 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15104 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15105 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015107ssl_c_used : boolean
15108 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15109 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015111ssl_c_verify : integer
15112 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15113 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15114 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15115 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015117ssl_c_version : integer
15118 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15119 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015120
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015121ssl_f_der : binary
15122 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15123 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15124 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015126ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15127 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15128 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15129 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15130 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015131 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15133 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15134 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015136ssl_f_key_alg : string
15137 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15138 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15139 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015141ssl_f_notafter : string
15142 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15143 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15144 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015146ssl_f_notbefore : string
15147 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15148 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15149 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015151ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15152 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15153 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15154 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15155 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15156 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15157 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15158 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15159 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015161ssl_f_serial : binary
15162 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15163 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15164 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015165
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015166ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15167 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15168 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15169 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015171ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15172 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15173 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15174 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176ssl_f_version : integer
15177 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15178 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15179
15180ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015181 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15182 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15183 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015185 Example :
15186 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15187 listen http-https
15188 bind :80
15189 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15190 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15191
15192ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15193 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15194 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15195
15196ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015197 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015198 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15199 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15200 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15201 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15202 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15203 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15204 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15205 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207ssl_fc_cipher : string
15208 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15209 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015210
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015211ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15212 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15213 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015214 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015215
15216ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15217 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15218 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015219 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015220
15221ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15222 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15223 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15224 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015225 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015226 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015227
15228ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15229 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15230 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015231 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015233ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015234 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15235 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015236 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15237 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15238 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15239 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015240
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015241ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15242 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15243 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15244 wait until the handshake happened.
15245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15247 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015248 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15249 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15250 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15251 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015252
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015253ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015254 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015255 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15256 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015258ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015259 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15261 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15262 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15263 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15264 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15265 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15266 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015268ssl_fc_protocol : string
15269 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15270 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015271
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015272ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015273 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015274 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15275 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015277ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15278 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15279 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15280 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15281 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015282
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015283ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15284 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15285 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15286 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15287 BoringSSL.
15288
15289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015290ssl_fc_sni : string
15291 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15292 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15293 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15294 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15295 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15296
15297 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15298 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15299 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015300 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15301 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015303 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15305 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015307ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15308 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15309 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015310
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015311
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153127.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015313------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015315Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15316sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15317only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15318For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15319be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15320can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15321sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15322for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15323content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015325payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015326 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15328 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015330payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15331 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015332 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015333 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015334
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015335req.hdrs : string
15336 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15337 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15338 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15339 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15340
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015341req.hdrs_bin : binary
15342 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15343 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15344 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15345 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15346 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15347 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15348
15349 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15350
15351 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15352 str: <int:length><bytes>
15353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015354req.len : integer
15355req_len : integer (deprecated)
15356 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15357 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15358 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15359 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15360 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15361 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15362 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15363 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015365req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15366 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015367 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15368 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15369 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15370 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015372 ACL alternatives :
15373 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15376 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15377 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15378 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15379 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015381 ACL alternatives :
15382 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015386req.proto_http : boolean
15387req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15388 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15389 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15390 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15391 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15392 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15393 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15394 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015396 Example:
15397 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15398 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15399 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015400 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015402req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15403rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15404 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15405 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15406 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15407 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15408 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15409 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15410 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15413 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15414 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15415 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15416 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15417 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419 ACL derivatives :
15420 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015422 Example :
15423 listen tse-farm
15424 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15425 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15426 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15427 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15428 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15429 persist rdp-cookie
15430 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15431 # This is only useful makes sense if
15432 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15433 stick-table type string size 204800
15434 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15435 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15436 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015438 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15439 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15442rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15443 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15444 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15445 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15446 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448 ACL derivatives :
15449 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015450
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015451req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15452 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15453 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015454 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15455 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15456 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15457 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15458 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15461req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15462 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15463 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15464 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15465 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15466 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15467 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15468 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015470req.ssl_sni : string
15471req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15472 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15473 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15474 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15475 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15476 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15477 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15478 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15479 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15480 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15481 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15482 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15483 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015485 ACL derivatives :
15486 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488 Examples :
15489 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15490 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15491 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15492 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15493 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015494
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015495req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15496 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15497 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15498 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15499 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15500 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15501 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15502 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15503 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15504 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506req.ssl_ver : integer
15507req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15508 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15509 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15510 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15511 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15512 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15513 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15514 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015515 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518 ACL derivatives :
15519 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015520
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015521res.len : integer
15522 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15523 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15524 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15525 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15526 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15527 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15528 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15529 content inspection.
15530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15532 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015533 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15534 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15535 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15536 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15539 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15540 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15541 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15542 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015545
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015546res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15547rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15548 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15549 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15550 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15551 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15552 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15553 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15554 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556wait_end : boolean
15557 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15558 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015559 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015560 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15561 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015562 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15564 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015566 Examples :
15567 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15568 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15569 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15572 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15573 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15574 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15575 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15576 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15577 tcp-request content reject
15578
15579
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155807.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581--------------------------------------
15582
15583It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15584This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15585data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15586its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15587HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15588content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15589to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15590more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15591response are indexed.
15592
15593base : string
15594 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15595 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15596 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15597 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15598 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15599 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15600 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15601 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15602
15603 ACL derivatives :
15604 base : exact string match
15605 base_beg : prefix match
15606 base_dir : subdir match
15607 base_dom : domain match
15608 base_end : suffix match
15609 base_len : length match
15610 base_reg : regex match
15611 base_sub : substring match
15612
15613base32 : integer
15614 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15615 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15616 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015617 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15618 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15619 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620
15621base32+src : binary
15622 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15623 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15624 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15625 per-URL counters.
15626
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015627capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15628 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15629 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15630 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15631
15632capture.req.method : string
15633 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15634 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15635 because it's allocated.
15636
15637capture.req.uri : string
15638 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15639 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15640 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15641 allocated.
15642
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015643capture.req.ver : string
15644 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15645 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15646 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15647
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015648capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15649 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15650 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15651 The first entry is an index of 0.
15652 See also: "capture response header"
15653
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015654capture.res.ver : string
15655 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15656 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15657 persistent flag.
15658
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015659req.body : binary
15660 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15661 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15662 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15663 the first chunk is analyzed.
15664
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015665req.body_param([<name>) : string
15666 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15667 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15668 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15669 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15670 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15671 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15672 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15673 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15674 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15675 given.
15676
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015677req.body_len : integer
15678 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15679 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15680 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15681 "option http-buffer-request".
15682
15683req.body_size : integer
15684 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15685 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15686 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15687 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15688 "option http-buffer-request".
15689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690req.cook([<name>]) : string
15691cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15692 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15693 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15694 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15695 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15696 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15697 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15698 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15699 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15700
15701 ACL derivatives :
15702 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15703 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15704 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15705 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15706 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15707 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15708 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15709 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15712cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15713 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15714 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15717cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15718 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15719 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15720 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15721 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15724 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15725 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15726 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15727 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015728 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15730 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15731 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15732 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15735 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15736 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15737 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15738 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015739 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15742 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15743 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15744 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15745 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15746 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15747 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15748 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15749 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15752 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15753 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15754 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15755 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15758 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15759 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15760 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15761 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15762 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15763 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15764 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15765 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015766 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015768 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015770 ACL derivatives :
15771 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15772 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15773 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15774 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15775 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15776 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15777 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15778 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15779
15780req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15781hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15782 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15783 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15784 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15785 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15786 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15787 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15788 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15789 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15790 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15791
15792req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15793hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15794 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15795 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15796 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15797 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15798 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015799 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15801 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15802
15803req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15804hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15805 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15806 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15807 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15808 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15809 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15810 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15811 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15812
15813http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15814 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15815 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15816 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15817 basic auth is supported.
15818
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015819http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15820 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15821 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15822 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15823 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015824 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15825 basic auth is supported.
15826
15827 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015828 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15829 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15830 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15831 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015832
15833http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015834 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15835 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15837 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015839method : integer + string
15840 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15841 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15842 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15843 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15844 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15845 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15846 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015848 ACL derivatives :
15849 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015851 Example :
15852 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15853 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15854 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015856path : string
15857 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15858 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15859 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15860 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15861 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015862 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865 ACL derivatives :
15866 path : exact string match
15867 path_beg : prefix match
15868 path_dir : subdir match
15869 path_dom : domain match
15870 path_end : suffix match
15871 path_len : length match
15872 path_reg : regex match
15873 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015874
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015875query : string
15876 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15877 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15878 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15879 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015880 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015881 which stops before the question mark.
15882
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015883req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15884 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15885 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15886 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15887 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015889req.ver : string
15890req_ver : string (deprecated)
15891 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15892 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15893 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015895 ACL derivatives :
15896 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898res.comp : boolean
15899 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15900 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15901 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903res.comp_algo : string
15904 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15905 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15906 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908res.cook([<name>]) : string
15909scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15910 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15911 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15912 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914 ACL derivatives :
15915 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15918scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15919 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15920 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15921 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15924scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15925 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15926 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15927 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15930 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15931 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15932 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15933 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15934 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15935 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15936 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15937 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15938 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15941 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15942 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15943 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15944 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15945 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15948shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15949 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15950 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15951 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15952 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15953 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15954 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15955 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15956 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015958 ACL derivatives :
15959 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15960 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15961 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15962 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15963 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15964 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15965 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15966 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15967
15968res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15969shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15970 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15971 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15972 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15973 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15974 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015976res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15977shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15978 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15979 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15980 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15981 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15982 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15983 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015984
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015985res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15986 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15987 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15988 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15989 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015991res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15992shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15993 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15994 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15995 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15996 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15997 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15998 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016000res.ver : string
16001resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16002 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16003 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005 ACL derivatives :
16006 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16009 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16010 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016011 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016012 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16015 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017status : integer
16018 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16019 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16020 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016021
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016022unique-id : string
16023 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16024 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16025 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16026 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16027 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16028 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016030url : string
16031 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16032 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16033 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16034 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16035 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16036 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16037 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016039 ACL derivatives :
16040 url : exact string match
16041 url_beg : prefix match
16042 url_dir : subdir match
16043 url_dom : domain match
16044 url_end : suffix match
16045 url_len : length match
16046 url_reg : regex match
16047 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049url_ip : ip
16050 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16051 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16052 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16053 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16054 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16055 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16056 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058url_port : integer
16059 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16060 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16061 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16062 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016063
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016064urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16065url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16067 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016068 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16069 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16070 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16071 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16073 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016074 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16075 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077 ACL derivatives :
16078 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16079 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16080 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16081 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16082 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16083 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16084 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16085 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016086
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016088 Example :
16089 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16090 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16091 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16092 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016093
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016094urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16096 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16097 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016098
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016099url32 : integer
16100 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16101 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16102 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16103 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16104 is an unsigned integer.
16105
16106url32+src : binary
16107 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16108 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16109 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16110
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161127.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016113---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016115Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16116every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016117order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016119ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16120---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016121FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016122HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016123HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16124HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016125HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16126HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16127HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16128HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16129LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016130METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016131METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016132METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16133METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16134METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16135METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016136METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016137METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016138RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016139REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016140TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016141WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16142---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016143
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161458. Logging
16146----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016147
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016148One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16149provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16150very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16151provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16152state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016153to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016154headers.
16155
16156In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16157about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16158send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16159
16160 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16161 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16162 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16163 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16164 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016165 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016166 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016167
16168The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16169allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16170as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16171while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16172real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16173delay.
16174
16175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161768.1. Log levels
16177---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016178
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016179TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016180source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016181HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16182in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16183track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16184syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16185about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016186
16187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161888.2. Log formats
16189----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016190
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016191HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016192and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16193slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16194options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016195
16196 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16197 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16198 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16199 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16200 extents.
16201
16202 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16203 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16204 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16205 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16206 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16207
16208 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16209 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16210 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16211 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16212 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16213
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016214 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16215 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16216 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16217 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16218
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016219 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16220
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016221Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16222specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16223field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16224servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16225always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16226identifier.
16227
16228Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16229 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16230 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16231 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16232 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16233
16234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162358.2.1. Default log format
16236-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016237
16238This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16239as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16240format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16241
16242 Example :
16243 listen www
16244 mode http
16245 log global
16246 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16247
16248 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16249 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16250 (www/HTTP)
16251
16252 Field Format Extract from the example above
16253 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16254 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16255 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16256 4 'to' to
16257 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16258 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16259
16260Detailed fields description :
16261 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16262 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16263 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16264 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16265 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16266 and processed the connection.
16267 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16268
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016269In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16270"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16271connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16272
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016273It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16274will eventually disappear.
16275
16276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162778.2.2. TCP log format
16278---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016279
16280The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16281is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16282information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16283counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16284emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16285environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16286the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16287sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016288specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16289not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16290fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16291marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016292
16293 Example :
16294 frontend fnt
16295 mode tcp
16296 option tcplog
16297 log global
16298 default_backend bck
16299
16300 backend bck
16301 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16302
16303 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16304 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16305 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16306
16307 Field Format Extract from the example above
16308 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16309 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16310 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16311 4 frontend_name fnt
16312 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16313 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16314 7 bytes_read* 212
16315 8 termination_state --
16316 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16317 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16318
16319Detailed fields description :
16320 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016321 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16322 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16323 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016324 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016325 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016326 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016327
16328 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016329 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16330 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16331 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016332
16333 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16334 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16335 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016336 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16337 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16338 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16339 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016340
16341 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16342 and processed the connection.
16343
16344 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16345 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16346 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16347 applications.
16348
16349 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16350 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16351 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16352 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16353 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16354
16355 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16356 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16357 See "Timers" below for more details.
16358
16359 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16360 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16361 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16362 "Timers" below for more details.
16363
16364 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016365 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016366 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16367 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16368 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16369 details.
16370
16371 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16372 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16373 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16374 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16375 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16376
16377 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16378 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16379 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16380 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16381 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16382 for more details.
16383
16384 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016385 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016386 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16387 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16388 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016389 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016390
16391 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16392 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16393 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16394 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16395 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16396 caused by a denial of service attack.
16397
16398 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16399 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16400 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16401 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16402 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16403 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16404 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16405 denial of service attack.
16406
16407 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16408 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16409 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16410 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16411 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16412 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16413 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16414 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16415 be processed than on other servers.
16416
16417 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16418 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16419 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16420 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16421 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16422 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16423 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16424 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16425 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16426 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16427 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16428 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16429 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16430
16431 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16432 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16433 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16434 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16435 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16436 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016437 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016438 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16439
16440 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16441 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16442 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16443 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16444 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16445 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016446 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016447 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16448 occurs.
16449
16450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164518.2.3. HTTP log format
16452----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016453
16454The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16455is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16456the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16457are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16458emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16459generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16460"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16461which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016462frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16463is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016464
16465Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16466slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16467with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16468
16469 Example :
16470 frontend http-in
16471 mode http
16472 option httplog
16473 log global
16474 default_backend bck
16475
16476 backend static
16477 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16478
16479 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16480 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16481 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016482 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016483
16484 Field Format Extract from the example above
16485 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16486 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016487 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016488 4 frontend_name http-in
16489 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016490 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016491 7 status_code 200
16492 8 bytes_read* 2750
16493 9 captured_request_cookie -
16494 10 captured_response_cookie -
16495 11 termination_state ----
16496 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16497 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16498 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16499 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16500 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016501
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016502Detailed fields description :
16503 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016504 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16505 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16506 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016507 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016508 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016509 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016510
16511 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016512 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16513 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16514 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016515
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016516 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16517 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016518
16519 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16520 and processed the connection.
16521
16522 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16523 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16524 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16525
16526 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16527 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16528 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16529 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16530 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16531 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16532
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016533 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16534 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16535 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16536 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16537 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16538 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016539 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16540 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016541
16542 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16543 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016544 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016545
16546 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16547 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016548 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16549 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016550
16551 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16552 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16553 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16554 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16555 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016556 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16557 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016558
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016559 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16560 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16561 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16562 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16563 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16564 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16565 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016566 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016567
16568 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16569 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16570 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16571
16572 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16573 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16574 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16575 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16576 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16577 overflowing.
16578
16579 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16580 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16581 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16582 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16583 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16584 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16585 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16586 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16587
16588 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16589 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16590 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16591 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16592 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16593 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16594 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16595 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16596
16597 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16598 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16599 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16600 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16601 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16602 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16603 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16604
16605 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016606 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016607 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16608 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16609 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016610 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016611 system.
16612
16613 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16614 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16615 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16616 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16617 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16618 caused by a denial of service attack.
16619
16620 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16621 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16622 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16623 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16624 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16625 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16626 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16627 denial of service attack.
16628
16629 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16630 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16631 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16632 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16633 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16634 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16635 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16636 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16637 processed than on other servers.
16638
16639 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16640 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16641 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16642 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16643 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16644 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16645 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16646 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16647 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16648 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16649 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16650 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16651 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16652
16653 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16654 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16655 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16656 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16657 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16658 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016659 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016660 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16661
16662 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16663 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16664 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16665 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16666 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16667 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016668 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016669 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16670 occurs.
16671
16672 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16673 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16674 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16675 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16676 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16677 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16678 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16679 cookies" below for more details.
16680
16681 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16682 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16683 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16684 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16685 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16686 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16687 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16688 and cookies" below for more details.
16689
16690 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16691 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16692 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16693 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16694 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16695 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16696 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16697 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16698
16699
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200167008.2.4. Custom log format
16701------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016702
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016703The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016704mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016705
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016706HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016707Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16708separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16709prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16710
16711Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16712variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016713("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016714
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016715If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016716as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016717less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16718the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16719
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016720Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016721In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016722in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016723
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016724Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16725'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16726https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16727such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16728
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016729Flags are :
16730 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016731 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016732 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16733 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016734
16735 Example:
16736
16737 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16738 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16739
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016740 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16741
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016742At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16743
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016744 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16745 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016746
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016747the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016748
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016749 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16750 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16751 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016752
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016753and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16754
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016755 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16756 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016757
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016758Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16759
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016760 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016761 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016762 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16763 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16764 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016765 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16766 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16767 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016768 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016769 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16770 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016771 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016772 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16773 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016774 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016775 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016776 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016777 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016778 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016779 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016780 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016781 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16782 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16783 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16784 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16785 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016786 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016787 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16788 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016789 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016790 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16791 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016792 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16793 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16794 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016795 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016796 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16797 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016798 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016799 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16800 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16801 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016802 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016803 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016804 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16805 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16806 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16807 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016808 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016809 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016810 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016811 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016812 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016813 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016814 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16815 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16816 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016817 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016818 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16819 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016820 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016821 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16822 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016823 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016824 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016825 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016826 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016827
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016828 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016829
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016830
168318.2.5. Error log format
16832-----------------------
16833
16834When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16835protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16836By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16837"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016838will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016839logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16840
16841The format looks like this :
16842
16843 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16844 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16845 Connection error during SSL handshake
16846
16847 Field Format Extract from the example above
16848 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16849 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16850 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16851 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16852 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16853
16854These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16855failures.
16856
16857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168588.3. Advanced logging options
16859-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016860
16861Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16862just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16863options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16864for more information about their usage.
16865
16866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168678.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16868------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016869
16870It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16871haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16872commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16873monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16874ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16875
16876 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16877 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16878 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16879 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16880
16881 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16882 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16883 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016884 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016885 such as other load-balancers.
16886
16887 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16888 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16889 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16890
16891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168928.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16893----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016894
16895The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16896what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16897or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016898"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016899just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16900log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16901after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16902is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16903with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16904with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16905
16906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16908------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016909
16910Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16911for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16912"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16913retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16914raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16915a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16916file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16917you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16918"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16919
16920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169218.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16922--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016923
16924Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16925multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16926them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16927"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16928logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16929error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16930and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16931too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16932useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16933alternative.
16934
16935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169368.4. Timing events
16937------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016938
16939Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16940reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16941the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16942frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016943mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16944addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16945
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016946Timings events in HTTP mode:
16947
16948 first request 2nd request
16949 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16950 t tr t tr ...
16951 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16952 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16953 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16954 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16955 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16956
16957Timings events in TCP mode:
16958
16959 TCP session
16960 |<----------------->|
16961 t t
16962 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16963 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16964 |<------ Tt ------->|
16965
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016966 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016967 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016968 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16969 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16970 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016971 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016972 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
16973 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
16974 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
16975 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016976
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016977 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16978 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16979 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016980 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
16981 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
16982 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
16983 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
16984 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
16985 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016986
16987 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16988 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16989 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16990 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16991 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16992 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16993 request typed by hand during a test.
16994
16995 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16996 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016997 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016998 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16999 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17000 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17001 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017002
17003 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17004 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17005 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17006 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17007 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17008
17009 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17010 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17011 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17012 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17013 connection never established.
17014
17015 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17016 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17017 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17018 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17019 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17020 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17021 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17022 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17023 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17024 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17025 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17026
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017027 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17028 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17029 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17030 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17031 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17032 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17033
17034 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17035
17036 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17037 "Ta" can never be negative.
17038
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017039 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17040 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017041 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17042 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017043 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017044
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017045 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017046
17047 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017048 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17049 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017050
17051These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17052protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17053that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017054due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17055"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17056that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017057
17058Most common cases :
17059
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017060 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17061 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17062 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17063 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17064 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17065 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17066 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17067 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17068 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17069 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17070 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017071 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017072
17073 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17074 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17075 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17076 of ms on remote networks.
17077
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017078 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17079 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17080 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017081
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017082 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17083 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17084 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17085 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17086 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17087 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17088 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17089 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17090 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017091
17092Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17093
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017094 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017095 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017096 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017097
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017098 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017099 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17100 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17101
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017102 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017103 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17104 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17105 flags.
17106
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017107 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17108 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017109 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17110 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17111 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17112 the client connection was maintained open.
17113
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017114 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017115 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017116 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017117 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17118
17119
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171208.5. Session state at disconnection
17121-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017122
17123TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17124"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
171252-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17126each of which has a special meaning :
17127
17128 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17129 session to terminate :
17130
17131 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17132
17133 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17134 server explicitly refused it.
17135
17136 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17137 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17138 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17139 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017140 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017141
17142 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17143 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017144
17145 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17146 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17147 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17148 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17149 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17150
17151 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17152 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17153 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17154 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17155 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17156
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017157 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17158 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17159
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017160 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17161 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17162 backup connections when going up.
17163
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017164 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17165
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017166 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17167 send or receive data.
17168
17169 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17170 send or receive data.
17171
17172 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17173 with nothing left in the buffers.
17174
17175 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17176
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017177 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017178 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17179
17180 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17181 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17182 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17183 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17184 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17185
17186 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17187 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17188
17189 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17190 server (HTTP only).
17191
17192 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17193
17194 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17195 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17196 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17197
17198 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17199 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17200 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17201
17202 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17203
17204 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17205 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17206
17207 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17208 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17209 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17210
17211 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17212 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017213 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17214 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017215
17216 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17217 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17218 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17219 another server.
17220
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017221 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017222 server.
17223
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017224 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17225 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17226 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17227 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17228
17229 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17230 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17231 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17232 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17233
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017234 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17235 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17236 "use-server" rule).
17237
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017238 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17239
17240 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17241 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17242
17243 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17244
17245 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17246 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17247 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17248
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017249 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17250 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017251 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017252 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17253 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17254
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017255 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17256
17257 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17258 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17259
17260 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17261
17262 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17263
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017264The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17265was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017266helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17267starvation, attacks, etc...
17268
17269The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17270alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17271easier finding and understanding.
17272
17273 Flags Reason
17274
17275 -- Normal termination.
17276
17277 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17278 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17279 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17280 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17281
17282 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17283 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17284 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17285 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17286 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17287 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017288
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017289 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17290 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017291 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017292
17293 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17294 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17295 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17296
17297 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17298 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17299 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17300 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17301 the server takes too long to respond.
17302
17303 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17304 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17305 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17306 long a time to respond.
17307
17308 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17309 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17310 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17311 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017312 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17313 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017314
17315 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17316 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17317 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17318 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17319 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017320 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017321 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17322 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17323 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17324 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17325 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17326 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17327 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17328 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017329 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017330 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17331 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17332 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017333
17334 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17335 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017336 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17337 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17338 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17339 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017340
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017341 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17342 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017344 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017345 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17346 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017347 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017348 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17349 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17350
17351 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17352 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17353 503 or 504 here.
17354
17355 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17356 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17357 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17358 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17359 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17360
17361 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17362 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017363 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017364 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17365 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17366
17367 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17368 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17369 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17370 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17371 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17372 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17373 between haproxy and the server.
17374
17375 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17376 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17377 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17378 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17379 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17380 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17381 solution is to fix the application.
17382
17383 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17384 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17385 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17386 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17387 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17388 external attacks.
17389
17390 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17391 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017392 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017393 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17394 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17395
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017396 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17397 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17398 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017399 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017400 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017401
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017402 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17403 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17404 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17405 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017406 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17407 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17408 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17409 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17410 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017411
17412 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17413 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17414 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17415 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17416
17417 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17418 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17419 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17420 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17421
17422 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17423 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17424 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17425 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17426
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017427The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17428persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17429important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17430re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17431
17432 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17433
17434 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17435 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17436 set on a GET request.
17437
17438 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17439 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017440 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017441 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17442
17443 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17444 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17445 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17446
17447 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17448 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17449 already got a cookie.
17450
17451 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17452 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17453 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17454 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17455 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17456
17457 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17458 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17459 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17460
17461 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17462 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17463 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17464
17465 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17466 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17467
17468 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17469 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17470 then advertised in the response.
17471
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174738.6. Non-printable characters
17474-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017475
17476In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17477consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17478converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17479prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17480being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17481escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17482is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17483'}' when logging headers.
17484
17485Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17486issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17487containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17488
17489Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17490the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17491performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17492
17493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174948.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17495---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017496
17497Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17498achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017499section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017500cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17501the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17502the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017503locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017504not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17505user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17506a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17507wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17508
17509 Examples :
17510 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17511 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17512
17513 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17514 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17515
17516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175178.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17518---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017519
17520Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17521proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17522the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17523server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17524
17525Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17526response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017527section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017528
17529It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017530time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17531appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017532are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17533and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17534follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17535request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17536in the logs.
17537
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017538As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17539frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17540an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17541
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017542 Example :
17543 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17544 listen proxy-out
17545 mode http
17546 option httplog
17547 option logasap
17548 log global
17549 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17550
17551 # log the name of the virtual server
17552 capture request header Host len 20
17553
17554 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17555 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17556
17557 # log the beginning of the referrer
17558 capture request header Referer len 20
17559
17560 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17561 capture response header Server len 20
17562
17563 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17564 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17565
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017566 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017567 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17568
17569 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17570 capture response header Via len 20
17571
17572 # log the URL location during a redirection
17573 capture response header Location len 20
17574
17575 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17576 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17577 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17578 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17579 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17580
17581 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17582 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17583 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17584 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017585 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017586
17587 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17588 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17589 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17590 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17591 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017592 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017593
17594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175958.9. Examples of logs
17596---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017597
17598These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17599them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17600reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17601
17602 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17603 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17604 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17605
17606 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17607 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17608
17609 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17610 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17611 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17612
17613 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17614 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17615
17616 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17617 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17618 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17619
17620 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017621 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017622 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17623 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17624
17625 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17626 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17627 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17628
17629 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17630 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017631 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017632 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17633 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17634 to return the 502 and not the server.
17635
17636 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017637 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017638
17639 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17640 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17641 Nothing was sent to any server.
17642
17643 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17644 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17645
17646 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17647 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017648 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017649 send a 408 return code to the client.
17650
17651 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17652 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17653
17654 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17655 5 seconds ("c----").
17656
17657 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17658 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017659 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017660
17661 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017662 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017663 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17664 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17665 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17666 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17667 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017668
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017669
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200176709. Supported filters
17671--------------------
17672
17673Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17674accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17675unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17676
17677See also : "filter"
17678
176799.1. Trace
17680----------
17681
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017682filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017683
17684 Arguments:
17685 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17686 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17687
17688 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17689 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17690 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17691 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17692
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017693 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017694 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17695 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17696 amount of the parsed data.
17697
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017698 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017699
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017700This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17701callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17702information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17703filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17704
17705Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17706tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17707a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17708
17709
177109.2. HTTP compression
17711---------------------
17712
17713filter compression
17714
17715The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17716keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
17717when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
17718use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
17719used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
17720filters evaluation order.
17721
17722See also : "compression"
17723
17724
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200177259.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17726--------------------------------------------
17727
17728filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17729
17730 Arguments :
17731
17732 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17733 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17734 parsed.
17735
17736 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17737 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17738 part must be placed in its own scope.
17739
17740The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17741external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017742streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017743exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17744also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17745
17746SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17747the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17748
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017749For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017750"doc/SPOE.txt".
17751
17752Important note:
17753 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17754 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17755
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100177569.4. Cache
17757----------
17758
17759filter cache <name>
17760
17761 Arguments :
17762
17763 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17764
17765The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17766"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17767cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
17768other filter than cache is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to
17769explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when two or more filters are used
17770for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters
17771evaluation order.
17772
17773See also : section 10 about cache.
17774
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001777510. Cache
17776---------
17777
17778HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17779(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17780RAM.
17781
17782The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017783this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017784
17785If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17786independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17787when we try to allocate a new one.
17788
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017789The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017790
17791It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17792"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17793for more details.
17794
17795When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17796replaced by "<CACHE>".
17797
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001779810.1. Limitation
17799----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017800
17801The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17802
17803- If the response is not a 200
17804- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017805- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017806- If the response is not cacheable
17807
17808- If the request is not a GET
17809- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017810- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017811
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017812Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
17813filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
17814can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
17815example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
17816"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017817
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001781810.2. Setup
17819-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017820
17821To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17822the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17823
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001782410.2.1. Cache section
17825---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017826
17827cache <name>
17828 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17829 size of cache is mandatory.
17830
17831total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017832 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017833 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017834
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017835max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017836 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17837 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17838 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017839
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017840max-age <seconds>
17841 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17842 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17843 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17844 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17845 default.
17846
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001784710.2.2. Proxy section
17848---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017849
17850http-request cache-use <name>
17851 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17852 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17853 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17854 after this one.
17855
17856http-response cache-store <name>
17857 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17858 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17859 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17860 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17861
17862
17863Example:
17864
17865 backend bck1
17866 mode http
17867
17868 http-request cache-use foobar
17869 http-response cache-store foobar
17870 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17871
17872 cache foobar
17873 total-max-size 4
17874 max-age 240
17875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017876/*
17877 * Local variables:
17878 * fill-column: 79
17879 * End:
17880 */